UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C.  20549

 

FORM 10-K/A

 

Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended

 

November 30, 2002

Commission file number

 

0-28839

 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware

 

13-1964841

(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)

 

 

 

150 Marcus Blvd., Hauppauge, New York

 

11788

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

(Zip Code)

 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code         (631) 231-7750

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Name of Each Exchange on

 

Title of each class:

 

Which Registered

 

 

 

 

 

Class A Common Stock $.01 par value

 

Nasdaq Stock Market

 

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

 

None

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirement for the past 90 days.

 

Yes  o                   No  ý

 

Indicate by check mark whether Registrant is an accelerated filer (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2).

 

Yes  ý                   No  o

 

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (Sec 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.

 

 



 

The aggregate market value of the common stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant was $168,886,196 (based upon closing price on the Nasdaq Stock Market on May 30, 2003).

 

The number of shares outstanding of each of the registrant’s classes of common stock, as of

 

May 23, 2003 was:

 

Class

 

Outstanding

 

 

 

 

 

Class A common stock $.01 par value

 

20,651,374

 

Class B common stock $.01 par value

 

2,260,954

 

 



 

Table of Contents

 

PART I

1

 

 

 

 

Item 1 - Business

1

 

Item 2 - Properties

30

 

Item 3 - Legal Proceedings

30

 

Item 4 - Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders

31

 

 

 

PART II

32

 

 

 

 

Item 5 - Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity and Related Stockholder Matters

32

 

Item 6 - Selected Consolidated Financial Data

32

 

Item 7 - Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

34

 

Item 7a - Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

71

 

Item 8 - Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

72

 

Item 9 - Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

157

 

 

 

PART III

157

 

 

 

 

Item 10 - Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant

157

 

Item 11 - Executive Compensation

157

 

Item 12 - Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management

163

 

Item 13 - Certain Relationships and Related Transactions

164

 

 

 

PART IV

165

 

 

 

 

Item 14 - Controls and Procedures

165

 

 

 

PART IV

166

 

 

 

 

Item 15 - Exhibits, Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules and Reports on Form 8-K

166

 

 

 

SIGNATURES

171

 

i



 

PART I

 

Item 1 - Business

 

All tabular presentation is in thousands unless otherwise indicated.

 

(a)                                  Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The Company has restated its consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and for the quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002.  In addition, the Company has reclassified certain expenses from operating expenses to cost of sales for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for each of the quarters in the nine months ended August 31, 2002.  These restatement adjustments are the result of the misapplication of generally accepted accounting principles.

 

The net effect of all of the restatement adjustments is as follows:

 

 

 

Fiscal
2000

 

Fiscal
2001

 

First
Quarter
2002

 

Second
Quarter
2002

 

Third
Quarter
2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(Unaudited)

 

(Unaudited)

 

(Unaudited)

 

Increase (decrease) income/(increase) decrease (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

$

263

 

$

1,011

 

$

(1,308

)

$

(782

)

$

751

 

Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss)

 

263

 

1,011

 

(1,308

)

(782

)

751

 

Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss) per common share - diluted

 

$

0.01

 

$

0.05

 

$

(0.06

)

$

(0.03

)

$

0.04

 

 

1



 

The following table provides additional information regarding these restatement adjustments:

 

Effects of Restatement Adjustments on Net Income or Net Loss

(in thousands)

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease)
in Net Income for the
Fiscal Year Ended
November 30, 2000

 

(Increase) Decrease in
Net Loss for the Fiscal
Year Ended November
30, 2001

 

Increase (Decrease) in
Net Income for the
Nine Months Ended
August 31, 2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unaudited

 

Restatement adjustments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue recognition

 

$

(779

)

$

779

 

 

Timing of revenue

 

 

 

(15

)

$

(103

)

Litigation

 

 

 

(373

)

427

 

Foreign currency translation

 

 

 

(1,491

)

Inventory pricing

 

 

 

420

 

Sales incentives

 

1,884

 

910

 

847

 

Gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares

 

 

 

(1,556

)

Operating expense reclassification to cost of sales (2)

 

 

 

 

Total adjustment to pre-tax income (loss)

 

1,105

 

1,301

 

(1,456

)

(Provision for) recovery of income taxes

 

(842

)

(310

)

204

 

Minority interest  (1)

 

 

20

 

(87

)

Total effect on net income (loss)

 

$

263

 

$

1,011

 

$

(1,339

)

 


(1)                                  This adjustment reflects the impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.

 

(2)                                  This adjustment represents a reclassification of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs (which are components of operating expenses) to cost of sales.  This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or (loss) for any fiscal year or period presented herein.

 

See Note 2, “Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements”, of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported fiscal years 2000 and 2001 and Note 26, “Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data- As Restated”, of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported unaudited quarterly consolidated statements of operations data for the quarters ended February 28, 2001 through August 31, 2002 as a result of the restatements and reclassifications.

 

The following discussion addresses each of the restatement adjustments and the reclassification adjustment for the corrections of accounting errors.  Any references to quarterly amounts are unaudited.

 

Revenue recognition. The Company overstated net sales in each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2000 for shipments of product that did not conform to the technical requirements of the customer (i.e., the goods were non-conforming).  The Company did not properly evaluate this shipment of non-conforming goods as required in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No.  101 (SAB No.  101), “Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements”, which would preclude revenue recognition until the specific performance obligations have been met by the Company.  These product shipments resulted in the Company overstating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2000.

 

2



 

During the first quarter of fiscal 2001, the Company recorded a sales return of this fiscal 2000 non-conforming product sale. The recording of this product return (sales reversal) resulted in the Company understating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2001.

 

Timing of revenue.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company (overstated) understated net sales by $(976), $857, $(4,601), $(7,757) and $10,472, respectively, as the timing of revenue recognition was not in accordance with the established shipping terms with certain customers.  SAB 101 specifically states that delivery generally is not considered to have occurred unless the customer has taken title (which is, in this situation, when the product was delivered to the customer’s site).  Accordingly, the Company should have deferred revenue recognition until delivery was made to the customer’s site.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, gross profit was overstated (understated) by $34, ($19), $99, $562 and ($535), respectively.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, operating expenses were overstated (understated) by $0, $0, $17, $136 and ($130), respectively.

 

Litigation.  During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2001 and each of the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overestimated its provisions for certain litigation matters, thereby overstating cost of sales by $314, $176, $345 and $457 for each respective quarterly period.  Also, the Company understated operating expenses by $497 in the first quarter of fiscal 2002 as a result of not recording a settlement offer in the period the Company offered it.

 

During the second, third and fourth quarters of 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of 2002, the Company understated (overstated) operating expenses by $189, $302, $196, $78 and $276 and ($300), respectively as a result of inappropriately deferring costs related to an insurance claim.  The Company’s insurance company refused to defend the Company against a legal claim made against the Company.  The Company took legal action against the insurance company and was unsuccessful.  The Company was improperly capitalizing costs that were not probable of recovery.

 

Foreign currency translation.   During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company did not properly account for a change in accounting for its Venezuelan subsidiary as operating in a non-highly inflationary economy.  In fiscal 2001 and in prior years, Venezuela was deemed to be a highly-inflationary economy in accordance with certain technical accounting pronouncements. Effective January 1, 2002, it was deemed that Venezuela should cease to be considered a highly-inflationary economy, however, the Company did not account for this change.  The Company incorrectly recorded the foreign currency translation adjustment in other income rather than as other comprehensive income.  As a result, the Company understated other expenses, net, by $1,360 for the first quarter of fiscal 2002, overstated other income, net, by $71 for the second quarter of fiscal 2002 and understated other expenses, net, by $243 for the third quarter of fiscal 2002.  Also the Company overstated operating expenses by $41, $54 and $88 for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively.

 

Inventory pricing.  During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales related to an inventory pricing error that occurred at its Venezuelan subsidiary.  The Company was not aware of this pricing error until the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002 and, accordingly,

 

3



 

was not properly pricing its inventory at the lower of cost or market in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  As a result, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales by $387, ($2) and $35, for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively.

 

Sales incentives.  During fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment overestimated accruals for additional sales incentives (other trade allowances) that were not yet offered to its customers.  As a result, for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $1,884, $784 and $292, respectively.

 

Furthermore, during fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment was also not reversing earned and unclaimed sales incentives (i.e., cooperative advertising, market development and volume incentive rebate funds) upon the expiration of the established claim period.  As a result, for fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $126 and $555, respectively.

 

Gain on the Issuance of Subsidiary Shares.  During the second quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares by $1,735 due to expenses related to this issuance being charged to additional paid in capital.   This adjustment also reflects the impact of the other restatement adjustments on the calculation of the gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares of $179 that was originally recorded by the Company in the quarter ended May 31, 2002.  As a result, the Company decreased the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares and increased the additional paid in capital by $1,556.

 

Income taxes.  Income taxes were adjusted for the restatement adjustments discussed above for each period presented.

 

The Company also applied income taxes to minority interest amounts during all quarters of fiscal 2000 and 2001, as well as the first three quarters of fiscal 2002.  As a result of all these adjustments, the Company overstated (understated) the provision for/recovery of income taxes by $(842), ($310) and $(455) for fiscal 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively.

 

Operating expense reclassification.  The Company reclassified certain costs as operating expenses, which were included as a component of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs, which should have been classified as a component of cost of sales.  The effect of this reclassification on fiscal 2000 and 2001 was to increase cost of sales and decrease operating expenses by $17,962 and $20,024, respectively.  The effect of this reclassification for the nine months ended August 31, 2002 was to understate cost of sales and overstate operating expenses by $15,488.  This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or loss for any fiscal year or period presented herein.  This reclassification reduced gross margin by 1.0, 1.6 and 1.9 percentage points for fiscal years November 30, 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively.

 

4



 

(b)                                 General Development of Business

 

Audiovox was incorporated in Delaware on April 10, 1987, as successor to a business founded in 1960 by John J. Shalam, our President, Chief Executive Officer and controlling stockholder.  Its principal executive offices are located at 150 Marcus Boulevard, Hauppauge, New York 11788, and the telephone number is 631-231-7750.

 

5



 

The Company designs and markets a diverse line of products and provides related services throughout the world. These products and services include:

 

                                          handsets and accessories for wireless communications

                                          mobile entertainment and security products

                                          mobile electronic and accessories products and accessories

                                          consumer electronic products and accessories

 

The Company generally markets its products under the well-recognized Audiovox brand name, which it has used for over 38 years.  The Company was a pioneer in the wireless industry, selling its first vehicle-installed wireless telephone in 1984 as a natural expansion of its automotive aftermarket products business.  The Company’s extensive distribution network and its long-standing industry relationships have allowed the Company to benefit from growing market opportunities in the wireless industry and to exploit emerging niches in the consumer electronics business.

 

The Company operates in two primary markets:

 

                  Wireless communications.  The Wireless Company (Wireless), which accounts for approximately 66% of revenues, sells wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers.

 

                                          Mobile and consumer electronics.  The Electronics Group (Electronics), which accounts for approximately 34% of revenues, sells autosound, mobile video, mobile electronics and consumer electronics through domestic and international distribution channels primarily to mass merchants, power retailers, specialty retailers, new car dealers, original equipment manufacturers (OEMs), independent installers of automotive accessories and the U.S. military.

 

The business grew significantly in fiscal 2000, primarily because of increased sales of digital handsets, as the market continued to shift to digital technology from analog technology.

 

Prior to and including 2000, our wireless business increased as new subscribers came onto the carrier networks as a result of lower price-plans, the shift from analog to digital technologies and the shift from mobile to hand-held portable phones.  Since 2000, several factors have affected the Company.  New subscriber subscriptions slowed down, the consolidation within our wireless customer base created a more competitive market within a smaller number of customers and there was a slow down in the development of new technologies which slowed consumer demand for one technology to another.

 

The Electronics Group has been positively influenced by an increase in the sale of consumer electronic items such as FRS (Family Radio System) Radios and Mobile Video products.

 

6



 

The following table shows net sales by group and the increase in Electronics sales compared to a decrease in Wireless:

 

 

 

2000
As Restated (1)

 

2001
As Restated (1)

 

2002

 

Percent
Change
2000/2002

 

 

 

 

 

(millions)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wireless

 

$

1,394

 

$

979

 

$

727

 

(47.8

)%

Electronics

 

276

 

298

 

373

 

35.1

%

Total

 

$

1,670

 

$

1,277

 

$

1,100

 

(34.1

)%

 


(1)                            See Note 2 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

To remain flexible and limit our research and fixed costs, the Company does not manufacture its products.  Instead, the Company has relationships with a broad group of suppliers who manufacture its products. The Company works directly with its suppliers in feature design, development and testing of all of its products and performs certain software installations or upgrades for wireless products and some assembly functions for its electronics products.

 

The Company’s product development efforts focus on meeting changing consumer demand for technologically-advanced, high-quality products, and the Company consults with customers throughout the design and development process.  The Company stands behind all of its products by providing warranties and end-user service support.

 

Strategy

 

The Company’s objective is to leverage the well-recognized Audiovox brand name and its extensive distribution network to capitalize on the growing worldwide demand for wireless products and continue to provide innovative mobile and consumer electronics products in response to consumer demand. The key elements of the Company’s strategy are:

 

Enhance and capitalize on the Audiovox brand name. The Company believes that the “Audiovox” brand name is one of its greatest strengths. During the past 38  years, the Company has invested to establish the Audiovox name as a well-known consumer brand for communications and electronics products.  The Company’s wireless handsets generally bear the Audiovox brand name or are co-branded with either a wireless carrier or brand name of our supplier.  To further benefit from the Audiovox name, the Company continues to introduce new products using its brand name and licenses its brand name for selected consumer products.

 

Expand wireless technology offerings to increase market opportunities.  The Company intends to continue to offer an array of technologically-advanced wireless products, including the planned introduction of wireless handsets with cameras and enhanced Internet capabilities.  The Company’s wide selection of wireless products will allow it to satisfy different carrier demands, both domestically

 

7



 

and internationally.

 

Capitalize on niche market opportunities in the consumer electronics industry. The Company intends to continue to use its extensive distribution and supply networks to capitalize on niche market opportunities, such as navigation, mobile video, DVD’s and cruise controls,  in the consumer electronics industry. The Company believes that focusing on high-demand, high-growth niche products results in better profit margins and growth potential for its electronics business.

 

Continue to expand international presence.  During fiscal 2003,  the Company intends to continue to expand its international business, both in the Wireless and Electronics Groups,  as it plans to introduce new products compatible with international wireless technologies, such as GSM, CDMA and GPRS and expand the mobile video category.

 

Continue to outsource manufacturing to increase operating leverage.  One of the key components of the Company’s business strategy is outsourcing the manufacturing of its products. This allows the Company to deliver the latest technological advances without the fixed costs associated with manufacturing.

 

Continue to provide value-added services to customers and suppliers.  The Company believes that it provides key services, such as product design, development and testing, sales support, product repair and warranty and software upgrading, more efficiently than its customers and suppliers could provide for themselves.  The Company intends to continue to develop its value-added services as the market evolves and customer needs change.

 

(c)           Financial Information About Industry Segments

 

The Company’s industry segments are the Wireless Group and the Electronics Group.  Net sales, income before provision for income taxes and total assets attributable to each segment for each of the last three years are set forth in Note 23 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements included herein.

 

(d)                                 Narrative Description of Business

 

Wireless

 

Wireless, which accounts for approximately 66% of the Company’s revenues, markets wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers.

 

Wireless products and technology

 

Wireless sells an array of digital handsets, hand-held computing devices and accessories in a variety of technologies, principally CDMA.  In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002 digital products represented 78%, 89% and 96%, respectively, of Wireless’ total unit sales.  Wireless generally markets its wireless products under the Audiovox brand name or co-brands its products with its carrier customers, such as Verizon Wireless and Bell Distribution, Inc. or with the brand name of the supplier.

 

8



 

In addition to handsets, Wireless sells a complete line of accessories that includes batteries, hands-free kits, battery eliminators, cases and data cables.  In fiscal 2003, Wireless intends to continue to broaden its digital product offerings and introduce handsets with new features such as wireless handsets with cameras and enhanced Internet capabilities.

 

9



 

Wireless marketing and distribution

 

Wireless sells wireless products to wireless carriers and the carrier’s respective agents, distributors and retailers. In addition, a majority of its handsets are designed to meet carrier specifications.   In fiscal 2000, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, AllTel Communications, MCI Worldcom, Brightpoint, Inc. and Canadian Mobility.  One of these customers accounted for 61.7% of Wireless’ net sales for fiscal 2000 and 50.5% of the 2000 consolidated net sales.  In fiscal 2001, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, PrimeCo Personal Communications LP, Sprint Spectrum LP, Bell Distribution Inc. and Brightpoint, Inc.   One of these customers accounted for 44.8%  of Wireless’ net sales and 35.0% of consolidated net sales for fiscal 2001. In fiscal 2002, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, Bell Distribution, Inc., Sprint Spectrum LP, Telus Mobility and AllTel Communications.  Three of these customers accounted for 36%, 11% and 10%, respectively, of Wireless’ net sales for fiscal 2002.  All of these customers represented 71%  of Wireless’ net sales and 47% of consolidated net sales during fiscal 2002.

 

In addition, Wireless promotes its products through trade and consumer advertising, participation at trade shows and direct personal contact by its sales representatives. Wireless also assists wireless carriers with their marketing campaigns by scripting telemarketing presentations, funding co-operative advertising campaigns, developing and printing custom sales literature, logistic services, conducting in-house training programs for wireless carriers and their agents and providing assistance in market development.

 

Wireless operates approximately seven retail facilities under the name Quintex. In addition, Wireless licenses the trade name Quintex® to ten outlets in selected markets in the United States. Wireless also serves as an agent (in activating cell phone numbers) for the following carriers in selected areas: Tmobile, Nextel, Suncom, NTelos, AT & T Wireless, Verizon Wireless,  Sprint and Sprint Spectrum LP. For fiscal 2002, revenues from Quintex were 6.1% of total Wireless revenues and 4.1% of consolidated revenues.

 

Wireless’ policy is to ship its products within 24 hours of a requested shipment date from public warehouses in Florida, New York, California , New Jersey, Canada and Netherlands and from leased facilities located in New York and California.

 

Wireless product development, warranty and customer service

 

Although Wireless does not have its own manufacturing facilities, it works closely with both customers and suppliers in feature design, development and testing of its products. In particular, Wireless:

 

                                          with its wireless customers, determines future market feature requirements

                                          works with its suppliers to develop products containing those features

                                          participates in the design of the features and cosmetics of its wireless products

                                          tests products in its own facilities to ensure compliance with Audiovox standards

                                          supervises testing of the products in its carrier markets to ensure compliance with carrier specifications

 

Wireless’ Hauppauge facility is ISO-9001:1994 certified, which requires it to carefully monitor quality standards in all facets of its business.

 

10



 

Wireless believes customer service is an important tool for enhancing its brand name and its relationship with carriers. In order to provide full service to its customers, Wireless warranties its wireless products to the end-user for periods ranging from up to one year for portable handsets to up to three years for mobile car phones. To support its warranties, Wireless has approximately 1,950 independent warranty centers throughout the United States and Canada and has experienced technicians in its warranty repair stations at its headquarters facility. Wireless has experienced customer service representatives who interact directly with both end-users and its customers. These representatives are trained to respond to questions on handset operation and warranty and repair issues.

 

Wireless suppliers

 

Wireless purchases its wireless products from several manufacturers located in Pacific Rim countries, including Japan, China, South Korea, Taiwan and Malaysia. In selecting its suppliers, Wireless considers quality, price, service, market conditions and reputation. Wireless generally purchases its products under short-term purchase orders and does not enter into long-term contracts with its suppliers. Wireless considers its relations with its suppliers to be good. Wireless believes that alternative sources of supply are currently available, although there could be a time lag and increased costs if it were to have an unplanned shift to a new supplier.  Approximately 56% of Wireless’ 2002 purchases were from Toshiba, a related party (see Related Party Transaction of Item 7 - Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.)

 

Wireless competition

 

The market for wireless handsets and accessories is highly competitive and is characterized by intense price competition, significant price erosion over the life of a product whose life cycle has continued to shorten, demand for value-added services, rapid technological development and industry consolidation of both customers and manufacturers. Currently, Wireless’ primary competitors for wireless handsets include Motorola, Nokia, Kyocera and Samsung.

 

Wireless also competes with numerous established and new manufacturers and distributors, some of whom sell the same or similar products directly to its customers. Historically, Wireless’ competitors have also included some of its own suppliers and customers. Many of Wireless’ competitors offer more extensive advertising and promotional programs than it does.

 

Wireless competes for sales to carriers, agents and distributors on the basis of its products and services and price. As its customers are requiring greater value-added logistic services, Wireless believes that competition will continually be required to support an infrastructure capable of providing these services. Wireless’ ability to continue to compete successfully will largely depend on its ability to perform these value-added services at a reasonable cost.

 

Wireless’ products compete primarily on the basis of value in terms of price, features and reliability. There have been, and will continue to be, several periods of extreme price competition in the wireless industry, particularly when one or more or its competitors has sought to sell off excess inventory by lowering its prices significantly or carriers canceling or modifying sales programs.

 

11



 

As a result of global competitive pressures, there have been significant consolidations in the domestic wireless industry including:

 

                                          Cricket and Leap Wireless

                                          Verizon Wireless: Bell Atlantic, AirTouch Communications, GTE Mobilnet, PrimeCo Personal Communications LP, Frontier, Ameritech and Vodafone

                                          Cingular Wireless: SBC Communications and Bell South

                                          VoiceStream: Expanded into major markets through acquisition of Omnipoint

                                          Telus and Clearnet

 

These consolidations may result in greater competition for a smaller number of large customers and may favor one or more of its competitors over Wireless.

 

Electronics Group

 

Electronics Industry

 

The mobile and consumer electronics industry is large and diverse and encompasses a broad range of products. There are many large manufacturers in the industry, such as Sony, RCA, Panasonic, Kenwood, Motorola and JVC, as well as large companies that specialize in niche products. The Electronics Group participates in selected niche markets such as autosound, mobile video, vehicle security and selected consumer electronics.

 

The introduction of new products and technological advancements drives growth in the electronics industry.  For example, the transition from analog to digital technology is leading to the development of a new generation of consumer electronic products.  Some of these products include digital satellite radio, portable DVD, home and mobile video systems, navigation systems and FRS radios.

 

Electronics products

 

The Company’s electronics products consist of two major categories, mobile electronics and consumer electronics.

 

Mobile electronics products include:

 

                                          autosound products, such as radios, speakers, amplifiers, CD changers and satellite radios

                                          mobile video products, including overhead and center console mobile entertainment systems, video cassette players and DVD players

                                          automotive security and remote start systems

                                          automotive power accessories

                                          navigation systems

 

Consumer electronics include:

 

                                          home and portable stereos

 

12



 

                                          FRS two-way radios

                                          LCD televisions

 

The Electronics Group markets its products under the Audiovox® brand name, as well as several other Audiovox-owned trade names that include Prestige®, Pursuit® and Rampage™ and Code Systems, Inc. Sales by the Company’s Malaysian, Venezuelan and American Radio subsidiaries fall under the Electronics Group. For the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Electronics

 

13



 

Group’s sales by product category were as follows:

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

Percent
Change
2000/2002

 

 

 

 

 

(millions)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(As Restated)

 

(As Restated)

 

 

 

 

 

Mobile electronics

 

$

134.6

 

$

157.7

 

$

229.3

 

70.4

%

Sound

 

77.4

 

57.5

 

56.3

 

(27.3

)

Consumer electronics

 

60.5

 

80.3

 

86.5

 

43.0

 

Other

 

3.9

 

2.2

 

0.6

 

(82.1

)

Total

 

$

276.4

 

$

297.7

 

$

372.7

 

34.9

%

 

The increase in Electronic’s sales reflects new product introductions in the mobile and consumer electronics categories and a continuing trend in lower sound sales as automakers incorporate full-featured sound systems at the factory instead of as an aftermarket option.

 

In the future, the Electronics Group will continue to focus its efforts on new technologies to take advantage of market opportunities created by the digital convergence of data, communications, navigation and entertainment products.

 

Licensing

 

In the late 1990’s, the Company began to license its brand name for use on selected products, such as home and portable stereo systems.  Actual sales of licensed products are not included in the Company’s sales figures. However, licensed customers have reported sales of $43.6 million in licensed goods in 2002 compared to $24.0 million in 2001 for which the Company received license fees.  License sales promote the Audiovox brand name without adding any significant costs.  License fees are recognized on a per unit basis upon sale to the end-user and are recorded in other income.  License fees in 2002 approximated $922 compared to approximately $500 in 2001.

 

Electronics distribution and marketing

 

The Electronics Group sells its electronics products to:

 

                                               mass merchants

                                               chain stores

                                               specialty retailers

                                               distributors

                                               new car dealers

                                               the U.S. military

 

The Electronics Group also sells its products under OEM arrangements with domestic and/or international subsidiaries of automobile manufacturers such as Ford Corporation, Daimler Chrysler, General Motors Corporation and Nissan. OEM projects represent a significant portion of the Electronics Group sales, accounting

 

14



 

for approximately 14.0% of the Electronics Group’s sales in 2002 versus 17.1% in 2001. These projects require a close partnership with the customer as the Electronics Group develops products to their specific requirements. Three of the largest auto makers, General Motors, Daimler Chrysler and Ford require QS registration for all of their vendors. The Electronics Group’s Hauppauge facility is both QS 9000 and ISO 9001 registered.  In addition, Audiovox Electronics is Q1 rated for the Ford Motor Company.

 

In fiscal 2000, the Electronics Group’s five largest customers were Nissan, Wal-Mart, Target, Gulf States Toyota and Circuit City. They represented 21.3% of the Electronics Group’s net sales and 3.5% of consolidated net sales.  In fiscal 2001, the Electronics Group’s five largest customers were Wal-Mart, Target, Ford, KMart and Circuit City. They represented 27.0% of the Electronics Group’s net sales and 6.3% of consolidated net sales.  In fiscal 2002, the Electronics Group’s five largest customers were Circuit City, Target, Walmart, Sam’s Wholesale Club and Gulf States Toyota. They represented 25% of the Electronics Group’s net sales and 8% of the consolidated net sales.

 

As part of the Electronics Group’s sales process, the Electronics Group provides value-added management services including:

 

                                          product design and development

                                          engineering and testing

                                          technical and sales support

                                          electronic data interchange (EDI)

                                          product repair services and warranty

                                          nationwide installation network

 

The Electronics Group has flexible shipping policies designed to meet customer needs. In the absence of specific customer instructions, the Electronics Group ships its products within 24 to 48 hours from the receipt of an order. The Electronics Group makes shipments from public warehouses in Virginia, Nevada, Florida, New Jersey, California and Venezuela and from leased facilities located in New York.

 

Electronics product development, warranty and customer service

 

The Electronics Group works closely with its customers and suppliers in the design, development and testing of its products. For the Electronics Group’s OEM automobile customers, the Electronics Group performs extensive validation testing to ensure that its products meet the special environmental and electronic standards of the manufacturer. The Electronics Group also performs final assembly of products in its Hauppauge location. The Electronics Group’s product development cycle includes:

 

                                          working with key customers and suppliers to identify consumer trends and potential demand

                                          working with the suppliers to design and develop products to meet those demands

                                          evaluating and testing the products in our own facilities to ensure compliance with our standards

                                          performing software design and validation testing

 

The Electronics Group provides a warranty to the end-users of its electronics products, generally ranging from 90 days up to the life of the vehicle for the original owner on some of its automobile-installed products. To support its warranties, the Electronics Group has independent warranty centers throughout

 

15



 

the United States, Canada, Venezuela and Malaysia. At its Hauppauge facility, the Electronics Group has a customer service group that provides product information, answers questions and serves as a technical hotline for installation help for both end-users and its customers.

 

16



 

The Electronics Group Hauppauge facility is QS-9000:1998 / ISO-9001:1994 certified, which requires it to carefully monitor quality standards in all facets of its business.

 

Electronics suppliers

 

The Electronics Group purchases its electronics products from manufacturers located in several Pacific Rim countries, including Japan, China, South Korea, Taiwan, Singapore and Malaysia. The Electronics Group also uses several manufacturers in the United States for cruise controls, mobile video and power amplifiers. In selecting its manufacturers, the Electronics Group considers quality, price, service, market conditions and reputation. The Electronics Group maintains buying offices or inspection offices in Taiwan, South Korea, China and Hong Kong to provide local supervision of supplier performance such as price negotiations, delivery and quality control. The Electronics Group generally purchases its products under short-term purchase orders and does not have long-term contracts with its suppliers. The Electronics Group believes that alternative sources of supply are currently available, although there could be a time lag and increased costs if it were to have an unplanned shift to a new supplier.

 

The Electronics Group considers relations with its suppliers to be good. In addition, the Electronics Group believes that alternative sources of supply are generally available within 120 days.

 

Electronics competition

 

The Electronics Group’s business is highly competitive across all of its product lines and competes with a number of well-established companies that manufacture and sell similar products. The Electronics Group’s mobile electronics products compete against factory-supplied radios (including General Motors, Ford and Daimler Chrysler), security and mobile video systems . The Electronics Group’s mobile electronics products also compete in the automotive aftermarket against major companies such as Sony, Panasonic, Kenwood, Motorola and Pioneer. The Electronics Group’s consumer electronics product lines compete against major consumer electronic companies, such as JVC, Sony, Panasonic, Motorola, RCA and AIWA. Brand name, design, features and price are the major competitive factors across all of its product lines.

 

(e)                                  Financial Information About Foreign and Domestic Operations and Export Sales

 

The amounts of net sales and long-lived assets, attributable to each of the Company’s geographic segments for each of the last three fiscal years are set forth in Note 23 to the Company’s consolidated financial statements included herein.  During fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company exported approximately $246, $215 and $233 million, respectively,  in product sales.

 

Trademarks

 

The Company markets products under several trademarks, including Audiovox®, Prestige®, Pursuit® and Rampage™ . The trademark Audiovox® is registered in approximately 67 countries. The Company believes that these trademarks are recognized by customers and are therefore significant in marketing its products.

 

17



 

Other Matters

 

Equity Investments

 

The Company has investments in unconsolidated joint ventures which were formed to market its products in specific market segments or geographic areas. The Company seeks to blend its financial and product resources with local operations to expand its distribution and marketing capabilities. The Company believes its joint ventures provide a more cost-effective method of focusing on specialized markets. The Company does not participate in the day-to-day management of these joint ventures.

 

The Company’s significant joint ventures are:

 

Venture

 

Percentage
Ownership

 

Formation
Date

 

Function

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Audiovox Specialized Applications

 

50.0

%

1997

 

Distribution of products for van, RV and other specialized vehicles.

Bliss-Tel Company, Ltd.

 

20.0

%

1997

 

Distribution of wireless products and accessories in Thailand.

 

Employees

 

The Company employs approximately 1,000 people.  The Company’s headcount has been relatively stable for the past several years, but will change based upon economic conditions within the two groups. The Company considers its relations with its employees to be good. No employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements.

 

Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant

 

The directors and executive officers of the Company are listed below.  All officers of the Company are elected by the Board of Directors to serve one-year terms.  There are no family relationships among officers, or any arrangement or understanding between any officer and any other person pursuant to which the officer was selected.  Unless otherwise indicated, positions listed in the table have been held for more than five years.

 

Name

 

Age

 

Current Position

 

 

 

 

 

John J. Shalam

 

69

 

President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

 

 

 

 

Philip Christopher

 

54

 

Executive Vice President and a Director

 

 

 

 

 

Charles M. Stoehr

 

56

 

Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and a Director

 

18



 

Name

 

Age

 

Current Position

 

 

 

 

 

Patrick M. Lavelle

 

51

 

Senior Vice President and a Director

 

 

 

 

 

Ann M. Boutcher

 

52

 

Vice President, Marketing and a Director

 

 

 

 

 

Richard A. Maddia

 

44

 

Vice President, IS and a Director

 

 

 

 

 

Paul C. Kreuch, Jr.*

 

64

 

Director

 

 

 

 

 

Dennis F. McManus*

 

52

 

Director

 

 

 

 

 

Irving Halevy*

 

86

 

Director

 


*Member of the Audit and Compensation Committees

 

John J. Shalam has served as President, Chief Executive Officer and as Director of Audiovox or its predecessor since 1960.  Mr. Shalam also serves as President and a Director of most of Audiovox’s operating subsidiaries.  Mr. Shalam is on the Board of Directors of the Electronics Industry Association and is on the Executive Committee of the Consumer Electronics Association.

 

Philip Christopher, our Executive Vice President, has been with Audiovox since 1970 and has held his current position since 1983.  Before 1983, he served as Senior Vice President of Audiovox. Mr. Christopher is Chief Executive Officer of Audiovox’s wireless subsidiary, Audiovox Communications Corp.  From 1973 through 1987, he was a Director of our predecessor, Audiovox Corp.  Mr. Christopher serves on the Executive Committee of the Cellular Telephone Industry Association.

 

Charles M. Stoehr has been our Chief Financial Officer since 1979 and was elected Senior Vice President in 1990. Mr. Stoehr has been a Director of Audiovox since 1987.  From 1979 through 1990, he was a Vice President of Audiovox.

 

Patrick M. Lavelle has been a Vice President of the Company since 1980 and was appointed Senior Vice President in 1991. He was elected to the Board of Directors in 1993.  Mr. Lavelle is Chief Executive Officer and President of the Company’s subsidiary, Audiovox Electronics Corp.  Mr. Lavelle is also a member of the Board of Directors and Executive Committee of the Consumer Electronics Association and serves as Chairmen of its Mobile Electronics Division.

 

Ann M. Boutcher has been our Vice President of Marketing since 1984.  Ms. Boutcher’s responsibilities include the development and implementation of our advertising, sales promotion and public relations programs.  Ms. Boutcher was elected to the Board of Directors in 1995.

 

Richard A. Maddia has been our Vice President of Information Systems since 1992.  Prior thereto, Mr. Maddia was Assistant Vice President, MIS.  Mr. Maddia’s responsibilities include development and maintenance of information systems. Mr. Maddia was elected to the Board of Directors in 1996.

 

19



 

Paul C. Kreuch, Jr. was elected to the Board of Directors in February 1997.  Mr. Kreuch is a Managing Director of WJM Associates, Inc., a leading executive development firm.  Prior career responsibilities include Executive Vice President of NatWest Bank, N.A. from 1993 to 1996, and, before that, President of National Westminster Bank, USA.

 

Dennis F. McManus was elected to the Board of Directors in March 1998.  Mr. McManus is currently the Vice President - New Product Marketing at the LSSi Corporation.  Prior to that Mr. McManus had been self-employed as a telecommunications consultant.  Before that, he was employed by NYNEX Corp. for over 27 years, most recently as a Senior Vice President and Managing Director.  Mr. McManus held this position from 1991 through December 31, 1997.

 

Irving Halevy served on the Board of Directors from 1987 to 1997 and was re-elected to the Board of Directors in 2001.  Mr. Halevy is a retired professor of Industrial Relations and Management at Fairleigh Dickinson University where he taught from 1952 to 1986.  He was also a panel member of the Federal Mediation and Conciliation Service.

 

All of our executive officers hold office at the discretion of the Board of Directors.

 

Cautionary Factors That May Affect Future Results

 

We have identified certain risk factors that apply to either Audiovox as a whole or one of our specific business units.  You should carefully consider each of the following risk factors and all of the other information included or incorporated by reference in this Form 10-K.  If any of these risks, or other risks not presently known to us or that we currently believe not to be significant, develop into actual events, then our business, financial condition, liquidity, or results of operations could be materially adversely affected.  If that happens, the market price of our common stock would likely decline, and you may lose all or part of your investment.

 

We May Not Be Able to Compete Successfully in the Highly Competitive Wireless Industry.

 

The market for wireless handsets and accessories is highly competitive and is characterized by:

 

                                          intense price competition

                                          shorter product life cycles

                                          significant price erosion over the life of a product

                                          industry consolidation

                                          rapid technological development

                                          the demand by wireless carriers for value-added services provided by their suppliers

 

Our primary competitors for wireless handsets currently are Motorola, Nokia, Kyocera and Samsung.  In addition, we compete with numerous other established and new manufacturers and distributors, some of whom sell the same or similar products directly to our customers.  Historically, our competitors have also included some of our own suppliers and customers.  Many of our competitors offer more extensive advertising and promotional programs than we do.

 

20



 

During the last decade, there have been several periods of extreme price competition, particularly when one or more or our competitors has sought to sell off excess inventory by lowering its prices significantly.  In particular, when technologies changed in 2000 from analog to digital, several of our larger competitors lowered their prices significantly to reduce their inventories, which required us to similarly reduce our prices.  These price reductions had a material adverse effect on our profitability.  There can be no assurance that our competitors will not do this again, because, among other reasons, many of them have significantly greater financial resources than we do and can withstand substantial price competition.  Since we sell products that tend to have low gross profit-margins, price competition has had, and may in the future have, a material adverse effect on our financial performance.

 

The Electronics Business Is Highly Competitive; Our Electronics Business Also Faces Significant Competition from Original Equipment Manufacturers (OEMs).

 

The market for electronics is highly competitive across all three of our product lines.  We compete against many established companies who have substantially greater resources than us.  In addition, we compete directly with OEMs, including divisions of well-known automobile manufacturers, in the autosound, auto security, mobile video and accessories industry.  Most of these companies have substantially greater financial and other resources than we do.  We believe that OEMs have increased sales pressure on new car dealers with whom they have close business relationships to purchase OEM-supplied equipment and accessories.  OEMs have also diversified and improved their product lines and accessories in an effort to increase sales of their products.  To the extent that OEMs succeed in their efforts, this success would have a material adverse effect on our sales of automotive entertainment and security products to new car dealers.

 

Wireless Carriers and Suppliers May Not Continue to Outsource Value-Added Services; We May Not Be Able to Continue to Provide Competitive Value-Added Services.

 

Wireless carriers purchase from us, rather than directly from our suppliers, because, among other reasons, we provide added services valued by our customers.  In order to maintain our sales levels, we must continue to provide these value-added services at reasonable costs to our carrier-customers and suppliers, including:

 

                                          product sourcing

                                          product distribution

                                          marketing

                                          custom packaging

                                          warranty support

                                          programming wireless handsets

                                          testing for carrier system acceptance

 

Our success depends on the wireless equipment manufacturers, wireless carriers, network operators and resellers continuing to outsource these functions rather than performing them in-house.  To encourage the use of our services, we must keep our prices reasonable.  If our internal costs of supplying these services increase, we may not be able to raise our prices to pass these costs along to our customers and suppliers.  As a result of the consolidations in the telecommunications industry, wireless carriers, which are the largest customers of our wireless business, may attempt to perform these services themselves.  Alternatively, our

 

21



 

customers and suppliers may transact business directly with each other rather than through us.  If our customers or suppliers begin to perform these services internally or do business directly with each other, it could have a material adverse effect on our sales and our profits.

 

Our Success Depends on Our Ability to Keep Pace with Technological Advances in the Wireless Industry.

 

Rapid technological change and frequent new product introductions characterize the wireless product market.  Our success depends upon our ability to:

 

                                          identify the new products necessary to meet the demands of the wireless marketplace and

                                          locate suppliers who are able to manufacture those products on a timely and cost-effective basis.

 

As a result of the emergence of the digital market, which resulted in the reduction of selling prices of analog hand-held phones, we recorded analog inventory write-downs to market of $8.2 million and $13.5 million in 2000 and 2001, respectively.  These write-downs had a material adverse effect on our profitability.   As a result of increasing pricing pressures and a surplus of supply created by other manufacturers also attempting to sell off analog inventories, there was a drop off in demand for analog products.  The write down was based upon the drop in demand, as carriers no longer promoted analog product and notified the Company that previous indications for orders of analog phones were no longer viable. Also during 2001, the Company recorded an additional inventory write-down to market of $7,150 associated with older digital products as newer products were being introduced.

 

During 2002, Wireless recorded inventory write-downs totaling of $13,823 pertaining to its digital inventory due to more current technological advances in the market.  This write-down was made based upon open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations. There can be no assurance that this will not occur again given the emergence of new technologies.

 

Since we do not make any of our own products and do not conduct our own research, we cannot assure you that we will be able to source the products that advances in technology require to remain competitive.  Furthermore, the introduction or expected introduction of new products or technologies may depress sales of existing products and technologies.  This may result in declining prices and inventory obsolescence.  Since we maintain a substantial investment in product inventory, declining prices and inventory obsolescence could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results. (See further discussions in Business Overview Page 37).

 

We Depend on a Small Number of Key Customers For a Large Percentage of Our Sales.

 

The wireless industry is characterized by a small number of key customers.  In fiscal 2000, 75% of our wireless sales were to five customers, and for 2001 70% of our wireless sales were to five customers.  Our five largest customers accounted for 71% of our wireless sales in fiscal 2002, one of which accounted for 36% of our wireless sales in fiscal 2002.  The loss of one or more of these customers would have a material impact on our business.

 

22



 

We Do Not Have Long-term Sales Contracts with Any of Our Customers.

 

Sales of our wireless products are made by written purchase orders and are terminable at will by either party.  The unexpected loss of all or a significant portion of sales to any one of our large customers could have a material adverse effect on our performance.  Sales of our electronics products are made by purchase order and are terminated at will at the option of either party.  We do not have long-term sales contracts with any of our customers.  The unexpected loss of all or a significant portion of sales to any one of these customers could result in a material adverse effect on our performance.

 

23



 

We Could Lose Customers or Orders as a Result of Consolidation in the Wireless Telecommunications Carrier Industry.

 

As a result of global competitive pressures, there has been significant consolidation in the domestic wireless industry:

 

                                          Cricket and Leap Wireless

                                          Verizon Wireless: Bell Atlantic, AirTouch Communications, GTE Mobilnet, Prime Co Personal Communications LP, Frontier, Ameritech and Vodafone

                                          Cingular Wireless: SBC Communications and Bell South

                                          VoiceStream: Expanded into major markets through acquisition of Omnipoint

                                          Telus and Clearnet

 

Future consolidations could cause us to lose business if any of the new consolidated entities do not perform as they expect to because of integration or other problems.  In addition, these consolidations will result in a smaller number of wireless carriers, leading to greater competition in the wireless handset market and may favor one or more of our competitors over us.  This could also lead to fluctuations in our quarterly results and carrying value of our inventory.  If any of these new entities orders less product from us or elects not to do business with us or changes current pricing in order to compete, it would have a material adverse effect on our business.  In fiscal 2002, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, Bell Distribution, Inc., Sprint Spectrum LP, Telus Mobility and AllTel Communications.  Three customers each accounted for 36%, 11% and 10%, respectively, of Wireless’ net sales for fiscal 2002. All of these customers represented 71% of Wireless’ net sales and 47% of consolidated net sales during fiscal 2002.

 

Sales in Our Electronics Business Are Dependent on New Products and Consumer Acceptance.

 

Our electronics business depends, to a large extent, on the introduction and availability of innovative products and technologies.  Significant sales of new products in niche markets, such as FRS two-way radios, known as FRS radios, portable DVD players and mobile video systems, have fueled the recent growth of our electronics business.  If we are not able to continually introduce new products that achieve consumer acceptance, our sales and profit margins will decline.

 

Since We Do Not Manufacture Our Products, We Depend on Our Suppliers to Provide Us with Adequate Quantities of High Quality Competitive Products on a Timely Basis.

 

We do not manufacture our products.  We do not have long-term contracts but have exclusive distribution arrangements with certain suppliers.  The suppliers can only sell their products through the Company for a given geographic or designated market area.   Most of our products are imported from suppliers under short-term purchase orders.  Accordingly, we can give no assurance that:

 

                                          our supplier relationships will continue as presently in effect

                                          our suppliers will be able to obtain the components necessary to produce high-quality, technologically-advanced products for us

                                          we will be able to obtain adequate alternatives to our supply sources should they be interrupted

 

24



 

                                          if obtained, alternatively sourced products of satisfactory quality would be delivered on a timely basis, competitively priced, comparably featured or acceptable to our customers

                                          exclusive geographic or market area distribution agreements will be renewed

 

Because of the increased demand for wireless and consumer electronics products, there have been, and still could be,  industry-wide shortages of components.  As a result, our suppliers have not been able to produce the quantities of these products that we desire.  Our inability to supply sufficient quantities of products that are in demand could reduce our profitability and have a material adverse effect on our relationships with our customers.  If any of our supplier relationships were terminated or interrupted, we could experience an immediate or long-term supply shortage, which could have a material adverse effect on us.  It is likely that our supply of wireless products would be interrupted before we could obtain alternative products.

 

Because We Purchase a Significant Amount of Our Products from Suppliers in Pacific Rim Countries, We Are Subject to the Economic Risks Associated with Changes in the Social, Political, Regulatory and Economic Conditions Inherent in These Countries.

 

We import most of our products from suppliers in the Pacific Rim.   Countries in the Pacific Rim have experienced significant social, political and economic upheaval over the past several years.  Because of the large concentrations of our purchases in Pacific Rim countries, particularly Japan, China, South Korea, Taiwan and Malaysia, any adverse changes in the social, political, regulatory and economic conditions in these countries may materially increase the cost of the products that we buy from our foreign suppliers or delay shipments of products, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.  In addition, our dependence on foreign suppliers forces us to order products further in advance than we would if our products were manufactured domestically.  This increases the risk that our products will become obsolete or face selling price reductions before we can sell our inventory.

 

We Plan to Expand the International Marketing and Distribution of Our Products, Which Will Subject Us to Additional Business Risks.

 

As part of our business strategy, we intend to increase our international sales, although we cannot assure you that we will be able to do so.  Conducting business outside of the United States subjects us to significant additional risks, including:

 

                                          export and import restrictions, tax consequences and other trade barriers

                                          currency fluctuations

                                          greater difficulty in accounts receivable collections

                                          economic and political instability

                                          foreign exchange controls that prohibit payment in U.S. dollars

                                          increased complexity and costs of managing and staffing international operations

 

For instance, our international sales have been affected by political unrest and currency fluctuation in Venezuela.  Any of these factors could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

25



 

Fluctuations in Foreign Currencies Could Have a Material Adverse Impact on Our Business.

 

We cannot predict the effect of exchange rate fluctuations on our future operating results.  Also, due to the short-term nature of our supply arrangements, the relationship of the U.S.  dollar to foreign currencies will impact price quotes when negotiating new supply arrangements denominated in U.S. dollars.  As a result, we could experience declining selling prices in our market without the benefit of cost decreases on purchases from suppliers or we could experience increasing costs without an ability to pass the costs to the customers.  We cannot assure you that we will be able to effectively limit our exposure to foreign currencies.  Foreign currency fluctuations could cause our operating results to decline and have a material adverse effect on our ability to compete.  Many of our competitors manufacture products in the United States or outside the Pacific Rim, which could place us at a competitive disadvantage if the value of the Pacific Rim currencies increased relative to the currency in the countries where our competitors obtain their products.

 

Trade Sanctions Against Foreign Countries or Foreign Companies Could Have a Material Adverse Impact on Our Business.

 

As a result of trade disputes, the United States and foreign countries have occasionally imposed tariffs, regulatory procedures and importation bans on certain products, including wireless handsets that have been produced in foreign countries.  Trade sanctions or regulatory procedures involving a country in which we conduct a substantial amount of business could have a material adverse effect on our operations.  Some of the countries we purchase products from are: China, Japan, South Korea, Taiwan and Malaysia.  China and Japan have been affected by such sanctions in the past.  In addition, the United States has imposed, and may in the future impose, sanctions on foreign companies for anti-dumping and other violations of U.S.  law.  If sanctions were imposed on any of our suppliers or customers, it could have a material adverse effect on our operations.

 

We May Not Be Able to Sustain Our Recent Growth Rates or Maintain Profit Margins.

 

Sales of our wireless products, a large portion of our business that operates on a high-volume, low-margin basis, have varied significantly over the past several years, from approximately $423 million in fiscal 1998 to approximately $1.4 billion for fiscal 2000 back to approximately $727 million in 2002.  Sales of our electronics products also increased significantly from approximately $182 million for fiscal 1998 to approximately $373 million for fiscal 2002.  We may not be able to continue to achieve this overall revenue growth rate or maintain profit margins because, among other reasons, of increased competition and technological changes.  This can be seen in the decline of our Wireless Group during 2000 from the changeover from analog to digital.   In addition, we expect that our operating expenses will continue to increase as we seek to expand our business, which could also result in a reduction in profit margins if we do not concurrently increase our sales proportionately.

 

If Our Sales During the Holiday Season Fall below Our Expectations, Our Annual Results Could Also Fall below Expectations.

 

Seasonal consumer shopping patterns significantly affect our business.  We generally make a substantial amount of our sales and net income during September, October and November, our fourth fiscal quarter.  We expect this trend to continue.  December is also a key month for us, due largely to the increase in promotional activities by our customers during the holiday season.  If the economy faltered in these periods, if our customers altered the timing or frequency of their promotional activities or if the effectiveness of these promotional activities

 

26



 

declined, particularly around the holiday season, it could have a material adverse effect on our annual financial results.

 

A Decline in General Economic Conditions Could Lead to Reduced Consumer Demand for the Discretionary Products We Sell.

 

Consumer spending patterns, especially discretionary spending for products such as consumer electronics and wireless handsets, are affected by, among other things, prevailing economic conditions, wage rates, inflation, consumer confidence and consumer perception of economic conditions.  A general slowdown in the U.S.  economy or an uncertain economic outlook could have a material adverse effect on our sales.  So far, the recent economic slowdown has not materially affected our business.  In addition, our mobile electronics business is dependent on the level of car sales in our markets.

 

We Depend Heavily on Existing Management and Key Personnel and Our Ability to Recruit and Retain Qualified Personnel.

 

Our success depends on the continued efforts of John J. Shalam, Philip Christopher, C.  Michael Stoehr and Patrick Lavelle, each of whom has worked with Audiovox for over two decades, as well as our other executive officers and key employees.  We only have one employment contract, with Philip Christopher and none with any other executive officers or key employees.    The loss or interruption of the continued full-time service of certain of our executive officers and key employees could have a material adverse effect on our business.

 

In addition, to support our continued growth, we must effectively recruit, develop and retain additional qualified personnel both domestically and internationally.  Our inability to attract and retain necessary qualified personnel could have a material adverse effect on our business.

 

We Are Responsible for Product Warranties and Defects.

 

Even though we outsource manufacturing, we provide warranties for all of our products for which we have provided an estimated liability.  Therefore, we are highly dependent on the quality of our suppliers.  The warranties for our electronics products range from 90 days to the lifetime of a vehicle for the original owner.  The warranties for our wireless products generally range from one to three years.  In addition, if we are required to repair a significant amount of product, the value of the product could decline while we are repairing the product.   In particular, in 1998, a software problem caused us to recall a specific line of analog handsets.  After a $1 million reimbursement from the manufacturer for warranty costs, this recall resulted in a net pre-tax charge of $6.6 million to cover the decline in the selling price of the product during the period we were repairing the handsets.    We cannot assure you that we will not have similar problems in the future.

 

Our Capital Resources May Not Be Sufficient to Meet Our Future Capital and Liquidity Requirements.

 

We believe that we currently have sufficient resources to fund our existing operations for the foreseeable future through our cash flows and borrowings under our credit facility.  However, we may need additional capital to operate our business if:

 

27



 

                                          market conditions change

                                          our business plans or assumptions change

                                          we make significant acquisitions

                                          we need to make significant increases in capital expenditures or working capital

 

We cannot assure you that we would be able to raise additional capital on favorable terms, if at all.  If we could not obtain sufficient funds to meet our capital requirements, we would have to curtail our business plans.  We may also raise funds to meet our capital requirements by issuing additional equity, which could be dilutive to our stockholders, though there can be no assurance that we would be able to do this.

 

Restrictive Covenants in Our Credit Facility May Restrict Our Ability to Implement Our Growth Strategy, Respond to Changes in Industry Conditions, Secure Additional Financing and Make Acquisitions.

 

Our credit facility contains restrictive covenants that:

 

                                          require us to attain specified pre-tax income

                                          limit our ability to incur additional debt

                                          require us to achieve specific financial ratios

                                          restrict our ability to make capital expenditures or acquisitions

 

If our business needs require us to take on additional debt, secure financing or make significant capital expenditures or acquisitions, and we are unable to comply with these restrictions, we would be forced to negotiate with our lenders to waive these covenants or amend the terms of our credit facility.  At May 31, 2001, November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, the Company was not in compliance with certain of its pre-tax income covenants.  Furthermore, as of November 30, 2002, the Company was also not in compliance with the requirement to deliver audited financial statements 90 days after the Company’s fiscal year-end, and as of February 28, 2003, the requirement to deliver unaudited quarterly financial statements 45 days after the Company’s quarter end.  The Company received a waiver for the November 30, 2001 pre-tax income violation subsequent to its issuance of the November 30, 2001 financial statements. In addition, the Company received waivers for the May 31, 2001 and February 28, 2002 violations.

 

The Company has not received waivers for the November 30, 2002 violation of a particular pre-tax income covenant or delivery of audited financial statements 90 days after the Company’s fiscal year-end.  Accordingly, as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company’s outstanding domestic obligations of $86,525 and 36,883, have been classified as current on the accompanying consolidated financial statements, respectively.  Management is in the process of requesting a waiver for the November 30, 2002 and February 28, 2003 violations.  While the Company was able to obtain waivers for such violations in 2001 and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, there can be no assurance that future negotiations with its lenders would be successful or that the Company will not violate covenants in the future, therefore, resulting in amounts outstanding to be payable upon demand.  Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company repaid its obligation of $36,883 in full resulting in bank obligations outstanding at May 15, 2003 of $0.  This credit agreement has no cross covenants with the other credit facilities described below.

 

28



 

Achieving pre-tax income is significantly dependant upon the timing of customer acceptance of new technologies, customer demand and the ability of our vendors to supply sufficient quantities to fulfill anticipated customer demand, among other factors.

 

There Are Claims of Possible Health Risks from Wireless Handsets.

 

Claims have been made alleging a link between the non-thermal electromagnetic field emitted by wireless handsets and the development of cancer, including brain cancer.  The television program 20/20 on ABC reported that several of the handsets available on the market, when used in certain positions, emit radiation to the user’s brain in amounts higher than permitted by the Food and Drug Administration.  The scientific community is divided on whether there is any risk associated with the use of wireless handsets and, if so, the magnitude of the risk.  Unfavorable publicity, whether or not warranted, medical studies or findings or litigation could have a material adverse effect on our growth and financial results.

 

In the past, several plaintiffs’ groups have brought class actions against wireless handset manufacturers and distributors, including us, alleging that wireless handsets have caused cancer.   To date, none of these actions has been successful.  However, actions based on these or other claims may succeed in the future and have a material adverse effect on us.

 

Several Domestic and Foreign Governments Are Considering, or Have Recently Adopted, Legislation That Restricts the Use of Wireless Handsets While Driving.

 

Several foreign governments have adopted, and a number of U.S.  state and local governments are considering or have recently enacted, legislation that would restrict or prohibit the use of a wireless handset while driving a vehicle or, alternatively, require the use of a hands-free telephone.  For example, Ohio and New York have adopted statutes that restricts the use of wireless handsets or requires the use of a hands-free kit while driving.  Widespread legislation that restricts or prohibits the use of wireless handsets while operating a vehicle could have a material adverse effect on our future growth.

 

Our Stock Price Could Fluctuate Significantly.

 

The market price of our common stock could fluctuate significantly in response to various factors and events, including:

 

                                          operating results being below market expectations

                                          announcements of technological innovations or new products by us or our competitors

                                          loss of a major customer or supplier

                                          changes in, or our failure to meet, financial estimates by securities analysts

                                          industry developments

                                          economic and other external factors

                                          period-to-period fluctuations in our financial results

                                          financial crises in foreign countries

                                          general downgrading of our industry sector by securities analysts

 

29



 

In addition, the securities markets have experienced significant price and volume fluctuations over the past several years that have often been unrelated to the operating performance of particular companies.  These market fluctuations may also have a material adverse effect on the market price of our common stock.

 

Our Securities Will Continue to be Listed on the Nasdaq National Market Pursuant to Exceptions.

 

Following the Company’s hearing with the Nasdaq related to its late filing of certain annual and quarterly forms with the SEC, the Company was notified that it must become timely in its filings and continue in the future to be timely to insure its continued listing on the Nasdaq National Market.

 

John J.  Shalam, Our President and Chief Executive Officer, Owns a Significant Portion of Our Common Stock and Can Exercise Control over Our Affairs.

 

Mr.  Shalam beneficially owns approximately 54% of the combined voting power of both classes of common stock.  This will allow him to elect our Board of Directors and, in general, to determine the outcome of any other matter submitted to the stockholders for approval.  Mr.  Shalam’s voting power may have the effect of delaying or preventing a change in control of Audiovox.

 

We have two classes of common stock: Class A common stock is traded on the Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbol VOXX, and Class B common stock, which is not publicly traded and substantially all of which is beneficially owned by Mr.  Shalam.  Each share of Class A common stock is entitled to one vote per share and each share of Class B common stock is entitled to ten votes per share.  Both classes vote together as a single class, except in certain circumstances, for the election and removal of directors and as otherwise may be required by Delaware law.  Since our charter permits shareholder action by written consent, Mr.  Shalam may be able to take significant corporate actions without prior notice and a shareholder meeting.

 

Item 2 - Properties

 

As of November 30, 2002, the Company leased a total of twenty-six operating facilities located in eleven states.  The leases have been classified as operating leases, with the exception of one, which is recorded as a capital lease.  Wireless utilizes ten of these facilities located in California, New York,  Virginia, Pennsylvania and Canada.  The Electronics Group utilizes 16 of these facilities located in California, Florida, Georgia, Massachusetts, New York, Ohio, Tennessee, Texas and Michigan. These facilities serve as offices,  warehouses,  distribution centers or retail locations for both Wireless and Electronics.  Additionally,  the Company utilizes public warehouse facilities located in Norfolk, Virginia and Sparks, Nevada for its Electronics Group and in Miami, Florida, Toronto, Canada, Farmingdale, New York, Rancho Dominguez, California and Tilburg, Netherlands for its Wireless Group.  The Company also leases facilities in Venezuela for its Electronics Group.

 

Item 3 - Legal Proceedings

 

The Company is currently, and has in the past been, a party to routine litigation incidental to its business.  From time to time, the Company receives notification of alleged violations of registered patent holders’ rights.   The Company has either been indemnified by its manufacturers in these matters, obtained the benefit of

 

30



 

a patent license or has decided to vigorously defend such claims.  On November 6, 2002, Audiovox Electronics Corporation (“AEC”) was served with a summons and complaint in an action for patent infringement that was instituted by Nissho Iwai American Corporation against AEC in the United State District Court for the Southern District of New York.  The complaint seeks equitable relief and damages for alleged infringement of a patent.  AEC has meritorious defenses to this claim and has decided to vigorously defend this action.  However, the Company cannot be certain of the outcome of this matter.

 

Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company and Audiovox Communications Corp. (“ACC”), along with other manufacturers of wireless phones and cellular service providers, were named as defendants in two class action lawsuits alleging non-compliance with FCC ordered emergency 911 call processing capabilities.   There are various procedural motions pending and no discovery has been conducted to date.  These lawsuits have been consolidated and transferred to the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois.  The Company and ACC intend to vigorously defend this matter.  However, no assurances regarding the outcome of this matter can be given at this point in the litigation.

 

In July 2002, Audiovox Communications Corp. instituted suit against Northcoast Communications, LLC in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of Suffolk seeking recovery of the sum of $1,818 as the balance due it for cellular telephones sold and delivered.  In its answer Northcoast interposed counterclaims including fraud, negligent misrepresentation and breach of contract seeking damages in excess of $10,000.  The parties have recently served discovery demands and no depositions have been taken to date.  Based on discussions with management and review of Audiovox’s documents, Northcoast’s counterclaims appear to be without merit and interposed to avoid payment of the underlying indebtedness.

 

The Company is the subject of an administrative agency investigation involving alleged reimbursement of a fixed nominal amount of federal campaign contributions during the years 1995 through 1996.  The Company has fully cooperated with the investigation and believes that it has committed no wrongdoing.

 

The Company had previously reported that during 2001, ACC, along with other suppliers, manufacturers and distributors as well as wireless carriers of hand-held wireless telephones had been named as a defendant in five state court class action lawsuits (Pinney, Farina, Gilliam, Gimpelson and Naquin) alleging damages relating to risk of exposure to radio frequency radiation from the wireless telephones.  These lawsuits were removed to their respective federal district courts and thereafter consolidated and transferred to a federal Multi-District Litigation Panel before the United States District Court for the District of Maryland.  On March 5, 2003, Judge Catherine C. Blake of the United States District Court for the District of Maryland granted the defendants’ consolidated motion to dismiss these complaints.  Plaintiffs have appealed to the United States Circuit Court of Appeals, Fourth Circuit.  It is anticipated that the appeal will be heard in late 2003 or early 2004.

 

The Company does not expect the outcome of any pending litigation, separately and in the aggregate, to have a material adverse effect on its business, consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

Item 4 - Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders

 

No matters were submitted to a vote of security holders during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002.

 

31



 

PART II

 

Item 5 - Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity and Related Stockholder Matters

 

Summary of Stock Prices and Dividend Data

 

The Class A Common Stock of Audiovox are traded on the Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbol VOXX.  No dividends have been paid on the Company’s common stock.  The Company is restricted by agreements with its financial institutions from the payment of common stock dividends while certain loans are outstanding (see Liquidity and Capital Resources of Management’s Discussion and Analysis).  There are approximately 566 holders of record of our Class A Common Stock and

four holders of Class B Convertible Common Stock.

 

Class A Common Stock

 

Fiscal Period

 

High

 

Low

 

Average
Daily
Trading
Volume

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2001

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

First Quarter

 

14.13

 

7.38

 

373,083

 

Second Quarter

 

12.13

 

7.28

 

162,019

 

Third Quarter

 

12.10

 

8.37

 

82,509

 

Fourth Quarter

 

9.39

 

5.90

 

105,022

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

First Quarter

 

8.25

 

6.00

 

117,420

 

Second Quarter

 

8.93

 

6.50

 

82,356

 

Third Quarter

 

9.05

 

5.95

 

91,708

 

Fourth Quarter

 

11.53

 

6.30

 

71,940

 

 

Item 6 - Selected Consolidated Financial Data

 

The following selected consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, the notes to the consolidated financial statements and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” which are included elsewhere in this report. The consolidated statements of operations data for each of the five fiscal years in the period ended November 30, 2002, and the consolidated balance sheet data as of the end of each such fiscal year, are derived from our audited consolidated financial statements (in thousands except per share data).

 

32



 

See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Recent Event” and Note 2, “Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements”, and Note 26, “Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data - As Restated” of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for more detailed information regarding the restatement of our consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and restated unaudited quarterly data for fiscal quarters during the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and the fiscal 2002 quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002, respectively.  The Company did not restate fiscal years ended November 30, 1998 and 1999 as any restatement amounts applicable to those years were not material and were recorded in 2000.

 

 

 

Years Ended November 30,

 

 

 

1998

 

1999

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

Consolidated  Statement of Operations Data

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales (1)(2)

 

$

606,108

 

$

1,149,537

 

$

1,670,291

 

$

1,276,591

 

$

1,100,382

 

Net income (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

2,972

 

27,246

 

25,303

 

(7,198

)

(14,280

)

Extraordinary item

 

 

 

2,189

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

 

 

 

 

240

 

Net income (loss)

 

2,972

 

27,246

 

27,492

 

(7,198

)

(14,040

)

Net income (loss) per common share before extraordinary item and cumulative effect:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

0.16

 

1.43

 

1.19

 

(0.33

)

(0.65

)

Diluted

 

0.16

 

1.39

 

1.12

 

(0.33

)

(0.65

)

Net income (loss) per common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

0.16

 

1.43

 

1.29

 

(0.33

)

(0.64

)

Diluted

 

0.16

 

1.39

 

1.22

 

(0.33

)

(0.64

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Balance Sheet Data

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

 

$

287,816

 

$

486,220

 

$

517,586

 

$

544,497

 

$

551,235

 

Working capital

 

160,609

 

272,081

 

305,369

 

284,166

 

292,687

 

Long-term obligations, less current installments

 

33,724

 

122,798

 

23,468

 

10,040

 

18,250

 

Stockholders’ equity

 

177,720

 

216,744

 

330,766

 

323,220

 

309,513

 

 


(1)                                  Effective March 1, 2002, the Company adopted Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 01-9, “Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer”.  Upon adoption of this Issue, the Company reclassified its sales incentives offered to its customers from selling expenses to net sales.  For purposes of comparability, these reclassifications have been reflected retroactively for all periods presented.

 

(2)                                  In fiscal 2001, the Company adopted the provisions of EITF Issue No. 00-10, “Accounting for Shipping and Handling Fees and Costs”, which requires the Company to report all amounts billed to a customer related to shipping and handling as revenue.  The Company has reclassified such billed amounts, which were previously netted in cost of sales, to net sales.  Gross profit has remained

 

33



 

unchanged by this adoption.  For purposes of comparability, these reclassifications have been reflected retroactively for all periods presented.

 

Item 7 - Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

 

Forward-looking Statements

 

This Report on Form 10-K contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Words such as “may,” “believe,” “estimate,” “expect,” “plan,” “intend,” “project,” “anticipate,” “continues,” “could,” “potential,” “predict” and similar expressions may identify forward-looking statements. The Company has based these forward-looking statements on its current expectations and projections about future events, activities or developments. The Company’s actual results could differ materially from those discussed in or implied by these forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements include statements relating to, among other things:

 

                                          growth trends in the wireless, automotive, mobile and consumer electronic businesses

                                          technological and market developments in the wireless, automotive, mobile and consumer electronics businesses

                                          liquidity

                                          availability of key employees

                                          expansion into international markets

                                          the availability of new consumer electronic products

 

These forward-looking statements are subject to numerous risks, uncertainties and assumptions about the Company including, among other things:

 

                                          the ability to keep pace with technological advances

                                          impact of future selling prices on Company profitability and inventory carrying value

                                          significant competition in the wireless, automotive and consumer electronics businesses

                                          quality and consumer acceptance of newly introduced products

                                          the relationships with key suppliers

                                            the relationships with key customers

                                          possible increases in warranty expense

                                          the loss of key employees

                                          foreign currency risks

                                          political instability

                                          changes in U.S. federal, state and local and foreign laws

                                          changes in regulations and tariffs

                                          seasonality and cyclicality

                                          inventory obsolescence and availability

                                          consolidations in the wireless and retail industries, causing a decrease in the number of carriers and retail stores that carry our products

                                          changes in global or local economic conditions

 

34



 

 

Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The Company has restated its consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and for the quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002.  In addition, the Company has reclassified certain expenses from operating expenses to cost of sales for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for each of the quarters in the nine months ended August 31, 2002.  These restatement adjustments are the result of the misapplication of generally accepted accounting principles.

 

The net effect of all of the restatement adjustments is as follows:

 

 

 

Fiscal
2000

 

Fiscal
2001

 

First
Quarter
2002

 

Second
Quarter
2002

 

Third
Quarter
2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(Unaudited)

 

(Unaudited)

 

(Unaudited)

 

Increase (decrease) income/(increase) decrease (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

$

263

 

$

1,011

 

$

(1,308

)

$

(782

)

$

751

 

Increase (decrease) net income/(increase) decrease net (loss)

 

263

 

1,011

 

(1,308

)

(782

)

751

 

Increase (decrease) net income/(increase) decrease net (loss) per common share - diluted

 

$

0.01

 

$

0.05

 

$

(0.06

)

$

(0.03

)

$

0.04

 

 

The following table provides additional information regarding these restatement adjustments:

 

Effects of Restatement Adjustments on Net Income or Net Loss
(in thousands)

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease)
in Net Income for the
Fiscal Year Ended
November 30, 2000

 

(Increase) Decrease in
Net Loss for the Fiscal
Year Ended November
30, 2001

 

Increase (Decrease) in
Net Income for the
Nine Months Ended
August 31, 2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unaudited

 

Restatement adjustments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue recognition

 

$

(779

)

$

779

 

 

Timing of revenue

 

 

 

 

(15

)

$

(103

)

Litigation

 

 

 

(373

)

427

 

Foreign currency translation

 

 

 

(1,491

)

Inventory pricing

 

 

 

420

 

Sales incentives

 

1,884

 

910

 

847

 

Gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares

 

 

 

(1,556

)

Operating expense reclassification to cost of sales (2)

 

 

 

 

  Total adjustment to pre-tax income (loss)

 

1,105

 

1,301

 

(1,456

)

(Provision for) recovery of income taxes

 

(842

)

(310

)

204

 

Minority interest (1)

 

 

20

 

(87

)

Total effect on net income (loss)

 

$

263

 

$

1,011

 

$

(1,339

)

 

35



 


(1)           This adjustment reflects the impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.

 

(2)                                  This adjustment represents a reclassification of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs (which are components of operating expenses) to cost of sales.  This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or (loss) for any fiscal year or period presented herein.

 

See Note 2, “Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements”, of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported fiscal years 2000 and 2001 and Note 26, “Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data- As Restated”, of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported unaudited quarterly consolidated statements of operations data for the quarters ended February 28, 2001 through August 31, 2002 as a result of the restatements and reclassifications.

 

The following discussion addresses each of the restatement adjustments and the reclassification adjustment for the corrections of accounting errors.  Any references to quarterly amounts are unaudited.

 

Revenue recognition. The Company overstated net sales in each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2000 for shipments of product that did not conform to the technical requirements of the customer (i.e., the goods were non-conforming).  The Company did not properly evaluate this shipment of non-conforming goods as required in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No.  101 (SAB No.  101), “Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements”, which would preclude revenue recognition until the specific performance obligations have been met by the Company.   These product shipments resulted in the Company overstating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2000.  During the first quarter of fiscal 2001, the Company recorded a sales return of this fiscal 2000 non-conforming product sale. The recording of this product return (sales reversal) resulted in the Company understating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2001.

 

Timing of revenue.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company (overstated) understated net sales by $(976), $857, $(4,601), $(7,757) and $10,472, respectively, as the timing of revenue recognition was not in accordance with the established shipping terms with certain customers.  SAB 101 specifically states that delivery generally is not considered to have occurred unless the customer has taken title (which is, in this situation, when the product was delivered to the customer’s site).  Accordingly, the Company should have deferred revenue recognition until delivery was made to the customer’s site.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, gross profit was overstated (understated) by $34, ($19), $99, $562 and ($535), respectively.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, operating expenses were overstated (understated) by $0, $0, $17, $136 and ($130), respectively.

 

Litigation.  During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2001 and each of the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overestimated its provisions for certain litigation matters, thereby overstating cost of sales by $314, $176, $345 and $457 for each respective quarterly period.  Also, the Company

 

36



 

understated operating expenses by $497 in the first quarter of fiscal 2002 as a result of not recording a settlement offer in the period the Company offered it.

 

During the second, third and fourth quarters of 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of 2002, the Company understated (overstated) operating expenses by $189, $302, $196, $78 and $276 and ($300), respectively as a result of inappropriately deferring costs related to an insurance claim.  The Company’s insurance company refused to defend the Company against a legal claim made against the Company.  The Company took legal action against the insurance company and was unsuccessful.  The Company was improperly capitalizing costs that were not probable of recovery.

 

Foreign currency translation.   During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company did not properly account for a change in accounting for its Venezuelan subsidiary as operating in a non-highly inflationary economy.  In fiscal 2001 and in prior years, Venezuela was deemed to be a highly-inflationary economy in accordance with certain technical accounting pronouncements. Effective January 1, 2002, it was deemed that Venezuela should cease to be considered a highly-inflationary economy, however, the Company did not account for this change.  The Company incorrectly recorded the foreign currency translation adjustment in other income rather than as other comprehensive income.  As a result, the Company understated other expenses, net, by $1,360 for the first quarter of fiscal 2002, overstated other income, net, by $71 for the second quarter of fiscal 2002 and understated other expenses, net, by $243 for the third quarter of fiscal 2002.  Also the Company overstated operating expenses by $41, $54 and $88 for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively.

 

Inventory pricing.  During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales related to an inventory pricing error that occurred at its Venezuelan subsidiary.  The Company was not aware of this pricing error until the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002 and, accordingly, was not properly pricing its inventory at the lower of cost or market in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  As a result, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales by $387, ($2) and $35, for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively.

 

Sales incentives.  During fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment overestimated accruals for additional sales incentives (other trade allowances) that were not offered to its customers.  As a result, for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $1,884, $784 and $292, respectively.

 

Furthermore, during fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002,the Electronics segment was also not reversing earned and unclaimed sales incentives (i.e., cooperative advertising, market development and volume incentive rebate funds) upon the expiration of the established claim period.  As a result, for fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $126 and $555, respectively.

 

Gain on the Issuance of Subsidiary Shares.  During the second quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares by $1,735 due to expenses related to this issuance being charged to additional paid in capital.   This adjustment also reflects the impact of the other restatement adjustments on the calculation of the gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares of $179 that was originally recorded by the Company in the quarter ended May 31, 2002.  As a result, the

 

37



 

Company decreased the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares and increased the additional paid in capital by $1,556.

 

Income taxes.  Income taxes were adjusted for the restatement adjustments discussed above for each period presented.

 

The Company also applied income taxes to minority interest amounts during all quarters of fiscal 2000 and 2001, as well as the first three quarters of fiscal 2002.  As a result of all these adjustments, the Company overstated (understated) the provision for/recovery of income taxes by $(842), ($310) and $(455) for fiscal 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively.

 

Operating expense reclassification.  The Company reclassified certain costs as operating expenses, which were included as a component of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs, which should have been classified as a component of cost of sales.  The effect of this reclassification on fiscal 2000 and 2001 was to increase cost of sales and decrease operating expenses by $17,962 and $20,024, respectively.  The effect of this reclassification for the nine months ended August 31, 2002 was to understate cost of sales and overstate operating expenses by $15,488.  This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or loss for any fiscal year or period presented herein.  This reclassification reduced gross margin by 1.0, 1.6 and 1.9 percentage points for fiscal years November 30, 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively.

 

Business Overview

 

The Company markets its products under the Audiovox brand name as well as private labels through a large and diverse distribution network both domestically and internationally.  The Company operates through two marketing groups: Wireless and Electronics. Wireless consists of Audiovox Communications Corp. (ACC), a 75%-owned subsidiary of Audiovox, and Quintex, which is a wholly-owned subsidiary of ACC.   ACC markets wireless handsets and accessories primarily on a wholesale basis to wireless carriers in the United States and carriers overseas.  Quintex is a small operation for the direct sale of handsets, accessories and wireless telephone service.  Quintex also receives residual fees and activation commissions from the carriers. Residuals are paid by the carriers based upon a percentage of usage of customers activated by Quintex for a period of time (1-5 years).  Quintex also sells a small volume of electronics products not related to wireless which are categorized as “other”.

 

The Electronics Group consists of three wholly-owned subsidiaries: Audiovox Electronics Corporation (AEC), American Radio Corp.  and Code Systems, Inc. (Code) and three majority-owned subsidiaries, Audiovox Communications (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd., Audiovox Holdings (M) Sdn. Bhd. and Audiovox Venezuela, C.A. The Electronics Group markets, both domestically and internationally, automotive sound and security systems, electronic car accessories, home and portable sound products, FRS radios, in-vehicle video systems, flat-screen televisions, DVD players and navigation systems.  Sales are made through an extensive distribution network of mass merchandisers and others.  In addition, the Company sells some of its products directly to automobile manufacturers on an OEM basis.  American Radio Corp. is also involved on a limited basis in the wireless marketplace.  Wireless related sales are categorized as “other”.

 

38



 

The Company allocates interest and certain shared expenses, including treasury, legal, human resources and information systems, to the marketing groups based upon both actual and estimated usage. General expenses and other income items that are not readily allocable are not included in the results of the two marketing groups.

 

From fiscal 1998 through 2002, several major events and trends have affected the Company’s results and financial conditions.

 

Wireless increased its handset sales from 3.3 million units in fiscal 1998 to an all-time high of  8.9 million units in fiscal 2000 as a result of the introduction of digital technology, reduced cost of service plans and expanded feature options which attracted more subscribers to the carriers systems. During 2001 through 2002, as a result of the change in technology from analog to digital,  the consolidation of our carrier customer base and increased price competition from our competitors, the Company’s overall wireless growth was impacted. Further during this period, the addition of several new competitors had an effect on the Company’s sales.  These factors resulted in a reduction of our net sales to 5.0 million units in 2002.  This overall trend in our wireless business from 1998 was impacted by:

 

                  the introduction of digital technology, which has allowed carriers to significantly increase subscriber capacity

                  reduced cost of service and expanded feature options

                  consolidation of carrier customers

                  price competition

                  increased competition

 

In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company recorded inventory write-downs to market of $8,152, $20,650 and $13,823, respectively.  These write-downs were primarily due to increased pricing pressures, competition and changing technologies.  Wireless’ gross profit margins were negatively impacted by 0.6, 2.1 and 1.8 percentage points, respectively, as a result of these write-downs.  This trend of competition, price erosion, and changing technologies will continue to affect the overall wireless business segment.

 

In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, Wireless recorded $8,265, $12,555 and $3,216, respectively, into income due to reversals of previously established sales incentive accruals.  Wireless’ gross profit margins were positively impacted by 0.6, 1.3 and 0.4 percentage points, respectively,  as a result of these reversals.  See further discussion in critical accounting policies.

 

Sales by the Electronics Group were $175.1 million in 1998 and $372.7 million in 2002.  During this period, the Company’s sales were impacted by the following items:

 

                  the growth of our consumer electronic products business from $11.7 million in fiscal 1998 to $86.5 million in fiscal 2002 was a result of the introduction of new consumer goods

                  the introduction of mobile video entertainment systems and other new technologies

                  growth of OEM business

 

39



 

Both of the Company’s segments, Electronics and Wireless, are influenced by the introduction of new products and changes in technology (see Cautionary Factors That May Affect Future Results:  Our success depends on our ability to keep pace with technological advances in the wireless industry).

 

During fiscal 2002, the Company introduced several new products in our Electronics segment, which included an extended line of portable DVD products for the consumer market, new flat panel TV’s and satellite radios.  In our Wireless group, the technology has evolved to new 1X technology, color view screens for the phones, PDA’s with built-in wireless capabilities and certain 1X phones have the availability to utilize the new GPS locator systems.  As a result of the continuous introduction of new products, the Company must sell existing older models prior to new product introduction or the value of the inventory may be impacted (See Critical Accounting Policies - Inventory, MD&A Discussions).

 

Gross margins in the Company’s electronics business have decreased to 16.1% for fiscal 2002 from 20.5% in 1998 due, in part, to a change in the product mix, partially offset by higher margins in mobile video products, other new technologies and products and the growth of the international business.

 

In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, Electronics recorded $0, $132 and $588, respectively, into income upon the expiration of unclaimed sales incentive accruals.  Electronics’ gross profit margins were positively impacted by 0.0, 0.1 and 0.2 percentage points, respectively,  as a result of this.

 

The Company’s total operating expenses have increased at a slower rate than sales since 1998.  Total operating expenses were $70.5 million in 1998 and $88.6 million in 2002. The Company has invested in management information systems and its operating facilities to increase its efficiency.

 

During the period 1998 to 2002, the Company’s financial position was improved by the 2.3 million share follow-on offering in which the Company received $96.6 million net proceeds and the sale of 25% of its previously 100%-owned subsidiary, ACC, to Toshiba for $27.2 million.

 

All financial information, except share and per share data, is presented in thousands.

 

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

 

General

 

The consolidated financial statements of the Company are prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. As such, the Company is required to make certain estimates, judgments and assumptions that management believes are reasonable based upon the information available.  These estimates and assumptions, which can be subjective and complex, affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the dates of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods.  As a result, actual results could differ from such estimates and assumptions.  The significant accounting policies which the Company believes are the most critical to aid in fully understanding and evaluating the reported consolidated financial results include the following:

 

40



 

Revenue Recognition

 

The Company recognizes revenue from product sales at the time of passage of title and risk of loss to the customer either at FOB Shipping Point or FOB Destination, based upon terms established with the customer.  Any customer acceptance provisions are satisfied prior to revenue recognition.  There are no further obligations on the part of the Company subsequent to revenue recognition except for returns of product from the Company’s customers.  The Company does accept returns of products, if properly requested, authorized, and approved by the Company.  The Company records an estimate of returns of products returned by its customers.  Management continuously monitors and tracks such product returns and records the provision for the estimated amount of such future returns, based on historical experience and any notification the Company receives of pending returns.  The Electronic segment’s selling price to its customers is a fixed amount that is not subject to refund or adjustment or contingent upon additional rebates.   The Wireless segment has sales agreements with certain customers that provide for a rebate of the selling price if the particular product is subsequently sold at a lower price.  The Wireless segment records an estimate of the rebate at the time of sale.

 

Accounts Receivable

 

The Company performs ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and adjusts credit limits based upon payment history and the customer’s current credit worthiness, as determined by a review of their current credit information.  The Company continuously monitors collections and payments from its customers and maintains a provision for estimated credit losses based upon historical experience and any specific customer collection issues that have been identified.  The Company’s reserve for estimated credit losses at November 30, 2002 was $6,829.  While such credit losses have historically been within management’s expectations and the provisions established, the Company cannot guarantee that it will continue to experience the same credit loss rates that have been experienced in the past.  Since the Company’s accounts receivable is concentrated in a relatively few number of customers, a significant change in the liquidity or financial position of any one of these customers could have a material adverse impact on the collectability of the Company’s accounts receivables and future operating results.

 

Sales Incentives

 

Both of the Company’s segments, Wireless and Electronics, offer sales incentives to its customers in the form of (1) co-operative advertising allowances; (2) market development funds and (3) volume incentive rebates.  The Electronics segment also offers other trade allowances to its customers.  The terms of the sales incentives vary by customer and are offered from time to time.  Except for other trade allowances, all sales incentives require the customer to purchase the Company’s products during a specified period of time.  All sales incentives require the customer to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period.  Although all sales incentives require customers to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period (referred to as the “claim period”), the Wireless segment historically has settled sales incentives claimed after the claim period has expired if a customer demands payment.  The sales incentive liabilities are settled either by the customer claiming a deduction against an outstanding account receivable owed to the Company by the customer or by the customer requesting a check from the Company.  The Company is unable to demonstrate that an identifiable benefit of the sales incentives has been received as such, all costs associated with sales incentives are classified as a reduction of net sales.  The following is a summary of the various sales incentive programs offered by the Company and the related accounting policies:

 

41



 

Co-operative advertising allowances are offered to customers as reimbursement towards their costs for print or media advertising in which our product is featured on its own or in conjunction with other companies’ products (e.g., a weekly advertising circular by a mass merchant).  The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company’s sales revenue or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period.  Market development funds are offered to customers in connection with new product launches or entering into new markets.  Those new markets can be either new geographic areas or new customers.  The amount offered for new product launches is based upon a fixed percentage of the Company’s sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period.  The Company accrues the cost of co-operative advertising allowances and market development funds at the later of when the customer purchases our products or when the sales incentive is offered to the customer.

 

Volume incentive rebates offered to customers require that minimum quantities of product be purchased during a specified period of time.  The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company’s sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer.  Certain of the volume incentive rebates offered to customers include a sliding scale of the amount of the sales incentive with different required minimum quantities to be purchased.  The customer’s achievement of the sales threshold and consequently the measurement of the total rebate for the Wireless segment cannot be reasonably estimated.  Accordingly, the Wireless segment recognizes a liability for the maximum potential amount of the rebate with the exception of certain volume incentive rebates that include very aggressive tiered levels of volume purchases, as the underlying revenue transactions that result in progress by the customer toward earning the rebate or refund on a program by program basis are recognized.  The Electronics segment makes an estimate of the ultimate amount of the rebate their customers will earn based upon past history with the customer and other facts and circumstances.  The Electronics segment has the ability to estimate these volume incentive rebates, as there does not exist a relatively long period of time for a particular rebate to be claimed, the Electronics segment does have historical experience with these sales incentive programs and the Electronics segment does have a large volume of relatively homogenous transactions.  Any changes in the estimated amount of volume incentive rebates are recognized immediately using a cumulative catch-up adjustment.

 

With respect to the accounting for co-operative advertising allowances, market development funds and volume incentive rebates, there was no impact upon the adoption of EITF 01-9, “Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer (Including a Reseller of Vendor’s Products)”, as the Company’s accounting policy prior to March 1, 2002 was consistent with its accounting policy after the adoption of EITF 01-9.

 

Other trade allowances are additional sales incentives that the Company provides to the Electronics segment customers subsequent to the related revenue being recognized.  In accordance with EITF 01-9, the Company records the provision for these additional sales incentives at the later of when the sales incentive is offered or when the related revenue is recognized.  Such additional sales incentives are based upon a fixed percentage of the selling price to the customer, a fixed amount per unit, or a lump-sum amount.

 

For the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, reversals of previously established sales incentive liabilities amounted to $9,348, $14,369 and $4,716, respectively.  These reversals include unearned sales incentives and unclaimed sales incentives.  Unearned sales incentives are volume incentive rebates where the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during the specified

 

42



 

time.  Volume incentive rebates for both segments are reversed into income in the period when the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during the specified time.  Unearned sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $4,167, $9,051 and $1,354, respectively.  Unclaimed sales incentives are sales incentives earned by the customer but the customer has not claimed payment of the earned sales incentive from the Company.  Unclaimed sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $5,181, $5,318 and $3,362, respectively.

 

The accrual for earned but unclaimed sales incentives is reversed by Wireless only when management is able to conclude, based upon an individual judgment of each sales incentive, that it is remote that the customer will claim the sales incentive.  The methodology applied for determining the amount and timing of reversals for the Wireless segment is disciplined, consistent and rational.  The methodology is not systematic (formula based), as the Company makes an estimate as to when it is remote that the sales incentive will not be claimed.  Reversals by the Wireless segment of unclaimed sales incentives have historically occurred in varying periods up to 12 months after the recognition of the accrual.  In deciding on whether to reverse the sales incentive liability into income, the Company makes an assessment as to the likelihood of the customer ever claiming the funds after the claim period has expired and considers the specific facts and circumstances pertaining to the individual sales incentive.  The factors considered by management in making the decision to reverse accruals for unclaimed sales incentives include (i) past practices of the customer requesting payments after the expiration of the claim period; (ii) recent negotiations with the customer for new sales incentives; (iii) subsequent communications with the customer with regard to the status of the claim; and (iv) recent activity in the customer’s account.

 

The Electronics segment reverses earned but unclaimed sales incentives upon the expiration of the claim period.  The Company believes that the reversal of earned but unclaimed sales incentives for Electronics upon the expiration of the claim period is a disciplined, rational, consistent and systematic method of reversing unclaimed sales incentives.  For the Electronics segment, the majority of sales incentive programs are calendar-year programs.  Accordingly, the program ends on the month following the fiscal year-end and the claim period expires one year from the end of the program.

 

The accrual for sales incentives at November 30, 2001 and 2002 was $8,474 and $12,151, respectively.  The Company’s sales incentive liability may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for these arrangements.  Therefore, although the Company makes its best estimate of its sales incentive liability, many factors, including significant unanticipated changes in the purchasing volume of its customers and the lack of claims made by customers of offered and accepted sales incentives, could have significant impact on the Company’s liability for sales incentives and the Company’s reported operating results.

 

Inventories

 

The Company values its inventory at the lower of the actual cost to purchase and/or the current estimated market value of the inventory less expected costs to sell the inventory.  The Company regularly reviews inventory quantities on-hand and records a provision for excess and obsolete inventory based primarily on open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations.  As demonstrated in recent years, demand for the Company’s products can fluctuate significantly.  A significant sudden increase in the demand for the Company’s products

 

43



 

could result in a short-term increase in the cost of inventory purchases while a significant decrease in demand could result in an increase in the amount of excess inventory quantities on-hand.  In addition, the Company’s industry is characterized by rapid technological change and frequent new product introductions that could result in an increase in the amount of obsolete inventory quantities on-hand.  In such situations, the Company generally does not obtain price protection from its vendors, however, on occasion, the Company has received price protection which reduces the cost of inventory.  Since price protection reduces the cost of inventory, as the Company sells the inventory for which it has received price protection, the amount is reflected as a reduction to cost of sales.  There can be no assurances that the Company will be successful in negotiating such price protection from its vendors in the future.

 

The Company has, on occasion, performed upgrades on certain inventory on behalf of its vendors.   The reimbursements the Company receives to perform these upgrades are reflected as a reduction to the cost of inventory and is recognized as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory is sold. Additionally, the Company’s estimates of excess and obsolete inventory may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for excess and obsolete inventory.  In the future, if the Company’s inventory is determined to be overvalued, it would be required to recognize such costs in its cost of goods sold at the time of such determination.  Likewise, if the Company does not properly estimate the lower of cost or market of its inventory and it is therefore determined to be undervalued, it may have over-reported its cost of goods sold in previous periods and would be required to recognize such additional operating income at the time of sale.  Therefore, although the Company makes every effort to ensure the accuracy of its forecasts of future product demand, any significant unanticipated changes in demand or technological developments could have a significant impact on the value of the Company’s inventory and its reported operating results.  During the year ended November 30, 2002, the Company recorded inventory write-downs to market of  $13,823 as a result of the recent reduction of selling prices primarily related to digital hand-held phones and other wireless products in anticipation and the introduction of new digital technologies as well as the overall decrease in demand for wireless products.  At November 30, 2002, Wireless had on hand 640,084 units of previously written-down inventory, which approximated $94,264.  It is reasonably possible that additional write-downs to market may be required in the future, given the continued emergence of new technologies.  (See Cautionary Factors That May Affect Future Results:  Our success depends on our ability to keep pace with technological advances in the wireless industry).

 

Warranties

 

The Company offers warranties of various lengths depending upon the specific product.  The Company’s standard warranties require the Company to repair or replace defective product returned to the Company by both end users and its customers during such warranty period at no cost to the end users or customers.  The Company records an estimate for warranty related costs based upon its actual historical return rates and repair costs at the time of sale, which are included in cost of sales. The estimated liability for future warranty expense amounted to $9,143 at November 30, 2002, which has been included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities.  While the Company’s warranty costs have historically been within its expectations and the provisions established, the Company cannot guarantee that it will continue to experience the same warranty return rates or repair costs that have been experienced in the past.  A significant increase in product return rates, or a significant increase in the costs to repair the Company’s products, could have a material adverse impact on its operating results for the period or periods in which such returns or additional costs materialize.

 

44



 

Income Taxes

 

The Company has accounted for, and currently accounts for, income taxes in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes”.  This Statement establishes financial accounting and reporting standards for the effects of income taxes that result from an enterprise’s activities during the current and preceding years.  It requires an asset and liability approach for financial accounting and reporting of income taxes.

 

The realization of tax benefits of deductible temporary differences and operating loss or tax credit carryforwards will depend on whether the Company will have sufficient taxable income of an appropriate character within the carryback and carryforward period permitted by the tax law to allow for utilization of the deductible amounts and carryforwards.  Without sufficient taxable income to offset the deductible amounts and carryforwards, the related tax benefits will expire unused. The Company has evaluated both positive and negative evidence in making a determination as to whether it is more likely than not that all or some portion of the deferred tax asset will not be realized.  Effective May 29, 2002, the Company’s ownership in the Wireless Group was decreased to 75% (see Note 3).  As such, the Company no longer files a consolidated U.S. Federal tax return.  As a result, the realizability of the Wireless Group’s deferred tax assets are assessed on a stand-alone basis.  The Company’s Wireless Group has incurred cumulative losses in recent years, and therefore based upon these cumulative losses and other material factors (including the Wireless Group’s inability to reasonably and accurately estimate future operating and taxable income based upon the volatility of their historical operations), the Company has determined that it is more likely than not that some of the benefits of the Wireless Group’s deferred tax assets and carryforwards will expire unused.  Accordingly, the Company has recorded an additional valuation allowance of $13,090 during fiscal year ended November 30, 2002 related to the Wireless Group’s deferred tax assets.

 

Furthermore, the Company provides tax reserves for Federal, state and international exposures relating to potential tax examination issues, planning initiatives and compliance responsibilities. The development of these reserves requires judgments about tax issues, potential outcomes and timing and is a subjective critical estimate.

 

45



 

Results of Operations

 

The following table sets forth for the periods indicated certain statements of operations data for the Company expressed as a percentage of net sales:

 

 

 

Percentage of Net Sales
Years Ended November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

Net sales (a):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wireless

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wireless products

 

81.4

%

74.3

%

63.7

%

Activation commissions

 

1.7

 

2.1

 

2.2

 

Residual fees

 

0.1

 

0.2

 

0.2

 

Other

 

0.2

 

0.1

 

0.1

 

Total Wireless

 

83.4

 

76.7

 

66.1

 

Electronics

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mobile electronics

 

8.1

 

12.4

 

20.8

 

Sound

 

4.6

 

4.5

 

5.1

 

Consumer electronics

 

3.6

 

6.3

 

7.9

 

Other

 

0.2

 

0.1

 

0.1

 

Total Electronics

 

16.6

 

23.6

 

33.9

 

Total net sales

 

100.0

 

100.0

 

100.0

 

Cost of sales

 

(92.9

)

(94.4

)

(93.2

)

Gross profit

 

7.1

 

5.6

 

6.8

 

Selling

 

(1.7

)

(2.4

)

(2.7

)

General and administrative

 

(2.8

)

(3.6

)

(5.0

)

Warehousing and technical support

 

(0.2

)

(0.3

)

(0.4

)

Total operating expenses

 

(4.7

)

(6.3

)

(8.1

)

Operating income (loss)

 

2.4

 

(0.7

)

(1.3

)

Interest and bank charges

 

(0.4

)

(0.5

)

(0.4

)

Equity in income in equity investments

 

0.2

 

0.3

 

0.2

 

Gain on sale of investments

 

0.1

 

 

 

Gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities

 

0.1

 

 

 

Gain on issuance of subsidiary shares

 

 

 

1.3

 

Other, net

 

0.1

 

 

(0.4

)

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest, extraordinary item and cumulative effect

 

2.5

 

(0.9

)

(0.6

)

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

0.9

 

(0.3

)

1.2

 

Minority interest

 

(0.1

)

0.1

 

0.4

 

Extraordinary item

 

0.1

 

 

 

Cumulative effect

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

1.6

%

(0.6

)%

(1.3

)%

 

46



 


(a)                                  Effective March 1, 2002, the Company adopted Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 01-9, “Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer”.  Upon adoption of this Issue, the Company reclassified its sales incentives offered to its customers from selling expenses to net sales.  Previously reported operating income (loss) has remained unchanged by this adoption.  For purposes of comparability, these reclassifications have been reflected retroactively for all periods presented.

 

The net sales and percentage of net sales by product line and marketing group for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 are reflected in the following table.  Certain reclassifications and recaptionings have been made to the data for periods prior to fiscal 2002 in order to conform to fiscal 2002 presentation.

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wireless

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Products

 

$

1,359,366

 

81.4

%

$

948,921

 

74.3

%

$

700,658

 

63.7

%

Activation commissions

 

28,983

 

1.7

 

26,879

 

2.1

 

24,393

 

2.2

 

Residual fees

 

1,852

 

0.1

 

2,396

 

0.2

 

2,187

 

0.2

 

Other

 

3,619

 

0.2

 

692

 

0.1

 

420

 

0.1

 

Total Wireless

 

1,393,820

 

83.4

 

978,888

 

76.7

 

727,658

 

66.1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Electronics

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mobile electronics

 

134,563

 

8.1

 

157,706

 

12.4

 

229,327

 

20.8

 

Sound

 

77,412

 

4.6

 

57,456

 

4.5

 

56,281

 

5.1

 

Consumer electronics

 

60,547

 

3.6

 

80,380

 

6.3

 

86,472

 

7.9

 

Other

 

3,949

 

0.2

 

2,160

 

0.1

 

644

 

0.1

 

Total Electronics

 

276,471

 

16.6

 

297,702

 

23.3

 

372,724

 

33.9

 

Total

 

$

1,670,291

 

100.0

%

$

1,276,591

 

100.0

%

$

1,100,382

 

100.0

%

 

Fiscal 2001 (As Restated) Compared to Fiscal 2002

Consolidated Results

 

Net sales for fiscal 2002 were $1,100,382, a 13.8% decrease from net sales of $1,276,591 in fiscal 2001.  Wireless Group sales were $727,658 in fiscal year 2002, a 25.7% decrease from sales of  $978,888 in fiscal 2001.  Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased 29.3% to approximately 4,950,000 units in fiscal 2002 from approximately 7,000,000 units in fiscal 2001.  However, the average selling price of the Company’s handsets increased to $136 per unit in fiscal 2002 from $127 per unit in fiscal 2001 as a result of new product introductions.  Wireless sales were impacted by late introductions of new products by its vendor, delays in acceptances testing by our customers and slower growth in the wireless industry.

 

47



 

Electronics Group sales were $372,724 in fiscal 2002, a 25.2% increase from sales of $297,702 in fiscal 2001.  This increase was largely due to increased sales in the mobile video and consumer electronics product lines as newer digital video products were offered to our customers.  Offsetting some of this increase were sound sales, which continue to decline given the change in the marketplace as fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory rather than being sold in the aftermarket. This declining trend in sound systems is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line.  Sales by the Company’s international subsidiaries decreased 21.5% in fiscal 2002 to approximately $21,971 due to a 39.2% decrease in Venezuela due to political and economic instability and a 7.4% decrease in Malaysia as a result of lower OEM sales.  Sales were also impacted by increased sales incentives of $23,035, primarily in the Wireless Group.

 

Gross profit margin for fiscal 2002 was 6.8%, compared to 5.6% in fiscal 2001.  However, this increase in profit margin resulted primarily from lower inventory write-downs to market of $7,612 in 2002 compared to 2001.  During fiscal 2002, there was no significant impact to our gross profit margins on the subsequent sale of previously written-down inventory.  There was also a change in the mix of sales from Wireless product sales to Electronics product sales, which carry a higher gross margin.  Wireless margins were impacted by late product introductions by its suppliers.  This trend of late product introductions continues to have a major effect on the gross margins of the Wireless Group.  Margins declined to 16.1% from 16.5% in the Electronics Group.  Consolidated gross margins were also adversely impacted by increased sales incentives, principally in the Wireless Group.  Further trends in the operations will be discussed in detail in each individual marketing group MD&A discussion.

 

Operating expenses increased $8,049 to $88,675 in fiscal 2002, compared to $80,626 in fiscal 2001.   As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 8.1% in fiscal 2002 from 6.3% in fiscal 2001.  Major components of this increase were compensation expenses of $3,200  related to the sale of ACC shares to Toshiba and the impact of Code acquisition (Note 6 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements) of $1,852.  Additionally, bad debt expenses increased $2,948 principally in the Wireless Group as a result of economic conditions in South America and increased insurance expense, particularly with general liability insurance, of $1,167.  This increase in operating expenses was partially offset by reductions in employee benefits expense of $1,332 due to reduced bonuses and lower health care costs.  Operating loss for fiscal 2002 was $14,076, compared to operating loss of $9,236 in 2001.

 

Net loss for fiscal 2002 was $14,040 compared to net loss of $7,198 in fiscal 2001.  Loss per share for fiscal 2002 was $0.64, basic and diluted compared to $0.33 for fiscal 2001, basic and diluted.

 

48



 

Wireless Results

 

The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of operations data for Wireless expressed as a percentage of net sales:

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wireless products

 

$

948,921

 

96.9

%

$

700,658

 

96.3

%

Activation commissions

 

26,879

 

2.8

 

24,393

 

3.3

 

Residual fees

 

2,396

 

0.2

 

2,187

 

0.3

 

Other

 

692

 

0.1

 

420

 

0.1

 

Total net sales

 

978,888

 

100.0

 

727,658

 

100.0

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

21,980

 

2.2

 

14,291

 

2.0

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

13,108

 

1.3

 

11,148

 

1.5

 

General and administrative

 

16,077

 

1.6

 

21,522

 

3.0

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

2,761

 

0.3

 

2,593

 

0.4

 

Total operating expenses

 

31,946

 

3.2

 

35,263

 

4.9

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating loss

 

(9,966

)

(1.0

)

(20,972

)

(2.9

)

Other expense

 

(7,690

)

(0.8

)

(3,934

)

(0.5

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pre-tax loss

 

$

(17,656

)

(1.8

)%

$

(24,906

)

(3.4

)%

 

Wireless is composed of ACC and Quintex, both subsidiaries of the Company.

 

Net sales were $727,658 in fiscal 2002, a decrease of $251,230, or 25.7%, from fiscal 2001.  Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased by 2,050,000  units in fiscal 2002, or 29.3%, to approximately 4,950,000 units from 7,000,000 units in fiscal 2001.  This decrease was attributable to decreased sales of digital handsets due to delayed new product introductions, longer testing cycles required by our customers and overall lower demand for wireless products.  In addition, there was a $20,845 of a net increase in sales incentives expense compared to 2001 due to increased sales incentive programs and a reduction in the reversals for unclaimed sales incentives.  In connection with the introduction of the new 1X phones, one sales incentive program with a large customer resulted in an increase of $18,000 in sales incentives.  The reversals for unclaimed sales incentives decreased by $2,374 in fiscal 2002 compared to fiscal 2001 for Wireless due to more of the Company’s larger customers claiming earned sales incentives as compared to prior periods.  These sales incentive programs are expected to continue and will either increase or decrease based upon competition and customer demands.  The average selling price of handsets, however, increased to $136 per unit in fiscal 2002 from $127 per unit in fiscal 2001.  This increase was due to higher selling prices of the newly-introduced 1X digital products.  Gross profit margins remained essentially unchanged at 2.0% vs. 2.2% in 2001 due to the sales of new, higher margin products and lower inventory write-downs, offset by increased sales incentive programs.  The Company expects due to market conditions, competition and customer concentration, it

 

49



 

could experience increased sales incentives expense in the future.  Inventory write-downs were $20,650 in 2001 compared to $13,823 in 2002.   The write-downs recorded in 2002 were a result of the reduction of selling prices primarily related to older model, digital hand-held phones and other wireless products in anticipation of newer digital technologies.  At November 30, 2002, the Company had on hand approximately 640,084 units of previously written-down inventory which, after write-down, had an extended value of $94,264. The new technology that was introduced during the second quarter of 2002 was 1XXT and GPS phones.  In addition to inventory write-downs recorded in previous quarters, the Company determined the valuation of the older technology digital models on hand as of November 30, 2002 by reviewing open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon current negotiations.  The Company plans to sell these items to its existing customers during the next year.  A majority of the units that were previously written-down in fiscal 2001 have been sold.  The remaining balance of inventory previously written-down in fiscal 2001 is not material and will be sold in the next fiscal year.  None of this inventory was scrapped.   The Company expects that, due to market conditions and customer consolidation, it could experience additional write-downs in the future.  Gross margins were favorably impacted by reimbursement from a vendor for software upgrades performed on inventory sold of $1,615 and $1,331 for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively. Without this reimbursement, gross margins would have been lower by 0.1% and 0.2% for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively.  The Company has received price protection of $4,550 and $32,643 for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively,  from a vendor for certain inventory, of which $4,550 and $27,683 was recorded as a reduction to cost of sales, as related inventory was sold.  The other $4,960 in price protection for 2002 has been reflected as a reduction to the remaining inventory cost.  Without this price protection, gross profit margins would have been lower by 0.5% and 4.5% for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively.  The Company has an agreement with its vendor for additional future price protection with respect to specific inventory items, if needed.

 

Operating expenses increased $3,317 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001.  As a percentage of net sales operating expenses increased to 4.8% during fiscal 2002 compared to 3.3% in fiscal 2001.  Selling expenses decreased $1,960 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily in commissions of $2,246 from reduced sales in Mexico, $587 from reduced sales in Europe and the balance from lower over-all commissionable sales.  Travel and entertainment decreased $126 due to a reduction in the sales force and less international travel.  These decreases were partially offset by increases in advertising and trade show expense of $498 primarily due to increased sales promotions and broadcast media advertising of $274.  Numerous other individually insignificant fluctuations account for the remaining net change in selling expenses.  General and administrative expenses increased $5,445 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily in salaries of $2,818 due to $3,200 bonus payments associated with the Toshiba transaction (Note 3), insurance expense of $681 due to increased insurance premiums for general liability coverage,  occupancy costs of $128 due to increased rent, real estate taxes and utilities, bad debt expense of $2,853 primarily due to two accounts in Venezuela and Argentina as a result of the political and economic conditions and one account in the United States for slow payment.  The Company does not consider this a trend in the overall accounts receivable.  Depreciation and amortization increased $236 due to purchase of additional testing equipment as new 1X product is being introduced.  These increases were partially offset by decreases in travel and entertainment of $193 due to less salesmen traveling as a result of lower sales and a reduced budget for travel and entertainment, employee benefits of $634 as a result of reduction in profit bonus and reductions in health plan costs due to improved claim experience and licenses of $466 due to a non-recurring licensing fee. Warehousing and technical support expenses decreased $168 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily in direct labor, taxes and benefits of $130 and overseas buying offices of $107 due to lower expenses in the buying offices in South Korea as

 

50



 

a result of reduced sales.  These decreases were partially offset by an increase in travel of $69 due to increased travel for product compliance testing.  Numerous other individually insignificant fluctuations in various categories account for the remaining net change in operating expenses.   Pre-tax loss for fiscal 2002 was $24,906, compared to $17,656 for fiscal 2001.

 

Management believes that the wireless industry is extremely competitive and that this competition could affect gross margins and the carrying value of inventories in the future as new competitors enter the marketplace.  This pressure from increased competition is further enhanced by the consolidation of many of Wireless’ customers into a smaller group, dominated by only a few, large customers.  Also, timely delivery and carrier acceptance of new product could affect our quarterly performance.  These new products require extensive testing and software development which could delay entry into the market and affect our sales in the future.  In addition, given the anticipated emergence of new technologies in the wireless industry, the Company will need to sell existing inventory quantities of current technologies to avoid further write-downs to market.

 

Electronics Results

 

The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of income data for the Electronics Group expressed as a percentage of net sales:

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mobile electronics

 

$

157,706

 

53.0

%

$

229,327

 

61.5

%

Sound

 

57,456

 

19.3

 

56,281

 

15.1

 

Consumer electronics

 

80,380

 

27.0

 

86,472

 

23.2

 

Other

 

2,160

 

0.7

 

644

 

0.2

 

Total net sales

 

297,702

 

100.0

 

372,724

 

100.0

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

49,088

 

16.5

 

60,037

 

16.1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

14,449

 

4.9

 

15,944

 

4.3

 

General and administrative

 

19,547

 

6.6

 

23,300

 

6.2

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

1,134

 

0.3

 

1,137

 

0.3

 

Total operating expenses

 

35,130

 

11.8

 

40,381

 

10.8

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income

 

13,958

 

4.7

 

19,656

 

5.3

 

Other expense

 

(178

)

(0.1

)

(1,927

)

(0.5

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pre-tax income

 

$

13,780

 

4.6

%

$

17,729

 

4.8

%

 

Net sales were $372,724 in fiscal 2002, a 25.2% increase from net sales of $297,702 in fiscal 2001.  Mobile and consumer electronics’ sales increased over last year, partially offset by a decrease in Sound

 

51



 

and other.  Mobile electronics increased $71,621 (45.4%) during 2002 from 2001.  Sales of Mobile Video within the Mobile Electronics category increased over 59% in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001 as a result of the introduction of new video digital product, satellite radio and navigation products.  Consumer Electronics increased $6,092 (7.6%) to $86,472 in fiscal 2002 from $80,380 in fiscal 2001, primarily in sales of video-in-a-bag and portable DVD players.  These increases were partially offset by a decrease in the sound category, particularly AV and Prestige audio lines.  Given change in the marketplace, fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory rather than being sold in the aftermarket. This declining trend in sound systems is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line.  There was also an increase in sales incentives of $2,190 due to an increase in sales as compared to the prior year in the consumer goods category, which requires more promotion support.  As many sales incentive programs are based on a percentage of sales, the increase in sales resulted in an increase in sales incentives.  Net sales in the Company’s Malaysian subsidiary decreased from last year by approximately $933 (7.4%) primarily from lower OEM business.  The Company’s Venezuelan subsidiary experienced a decrease of $5,823 (39.2%) in sales from last year, primarily from lower OEM business and the impact of economic and political instability in the country.

 

Gross profit margins decreased to 16.1% in fiscal 2002 from 16.5% in fiscal 2001 despite an increase in sales.  The gross margin decreased in Sound, partially offset by an increase in Mobile Electronics and international operations.   Also affecting margins was the integration of Code Systems into the Electronics Group (see Note 6).  During 2002, the Company was in the process of converting Code from their own domestic manufacturing to having products produced by overseas vendors.  As a result, Code’s gross margins were significantly lower than other product lines in the Electronics Group.  Lower margins from Code were partially offset by higher margins in new models of consumer and mobile electronics.  This integration of Code has been completed.

 

Operating expenses increased $5,251 in fiscal 2002, a 14.9% increase from operating expenses in fiscal 2001.  As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses decreased to 10.8% during fiscal 2002 compared to 11.8% in fiscal 2001.  Selling expenses increased $1,495 during fiscal 2002, primarily in commissions of $911 due to increased commissionable sales in the video and consumer goods product categories, which has a different commission rate structure and grew faster than other product groups, salaries of $598 primarily due to Code, a new company, newly hired international salesmen and travel and entertainment of $144 due to increased travel to support increased business both in the Segment’s core business and its two subsidiaries, American Radio and Code.  These increases were partially offset by decreases of $262 in advertising and trade shows.  General and administrative expenses increased $3,753 from fiscal 2001, mostly in salaries of $1,713 primarily due to Code, increased bonuses due to sales increases and increased head count, travel and entertainment of $234 due to additional business and acquisitions, office expenses of $122 due to increased use of employment agencies, for additional staff to support sales growth, equipment repair of $101 due to increased maintenance of office equipment, insurance expense of $378 due to higher premiums on general liability and Ocean Cargo as shipments and sales have increased, professional fees of $589 due to litigation expenses related to royalties and other matters and increased use of consulting services related to a new customer’s navigation system, occupancy costs of $260 due to relocation of the display department to another separate facility, bad debt expense of $311 due to non-payment by an international customer, which is not indicative of a trend, and depreciation and amortization of $163 due to general expansion of the facilities to support the growing operations.  These increases were partially offset by decreases in equipment rentals of $111 due to the elimination of certain office machines. Warehousing and technical support expenses remained essentially unchanged at $1,137 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001 compared to $1,134

 

52



 

in fiscal 2002.  Pre-tax income for fiscal 2002 was $17,729, compared to $13,780 for fiscal 2001.

 

The Company believes that the Electronics Group has an expanding market with a certain level of volatility related to both domestic and international new car sales and general economic conditions.  Also, all of its products are subject to price fluctuations which could affect the carrying value of inventories and gross margins in the future.

 

Other Income and Expense

 

Interest expense and bank charges decreased $1,703 during fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily due to lower interest rates on lower borrowing levels.

 

Equity in income of equity investees decreased by approximately $1,807 for fiscal 2002 compared to fiscal 2001.  The majority of the decrease was due to a decrease in the equity income of ASA due to a general slow down in the market for their products.  Other expenses increased as a result of foreign exchange translation in our Venezuelan subsidiary as a result of the devaluation of the Venezuelan currency against the U.S. Dollar and the effects of the change from hyper-inflationary accounting for foreign exchange translation to non-hyper-inflationary accounting in fiscal 2002.  During fiscal 2001, the Company accounted for foreign exchange translation in its Venezuelan subsidiary under hyper-inflationary method.  The foreign exchange losses were $333 in 2001 and $2,819 in 2002.

 

In addition, the Company recorded an other-than-temporary impairment for investment in common stock of Shintom Co., Ltd. of $1,158.  The Company also recognized a gain of $14,269 on the sale of ACC shares to Toshiba (Note 3).

 

Provision for Income Taxes

 

The effective tax rate for 2001 was a (benefit) of (31.6%) as compared to the effective tax rate for 2002 which was an expense of 202.0%.  The increase in the effective tax rate is principally due to the increase in valuation allowance, relating to various deferred tax assets.  Effective May 29, 2002, the Company’s ownership in the Wireless Group was decreased to 75% (see Note 3).  As such, the Company now files two consolidated U.S. Federal tax returns, one for the Wireless Group and one for the Electronics Group.  As a result, the realizability of the Wireless Group’s deferred tax assets are assessed on a stand-alone basis.  The Company’s Wireless Group has incurred cumulative losses in recent years and therefore based upon these cumulative losses and other material factors (including the Wireless Group’s inability to reasonably and accurately estimate future operating and taxable income based upon the volatility of their historical operations), the Company has determined that it is more likely than not that some of the benefits of the Wireless Group’s deferred tax assets and carryforwards will expire unused, accordingly, the Company has recorded an additional valuation allowance of $13,090 during fiscal year ended November 30, 2002 related to the Wireless Group’s deferred tax assets. The increase in the valuation allowance relates principally to the deferred tax assets of the Wireless segment, which has recorded cumulative losses in recent years, and to certain state net operating losses which the Company has determined are more likely than not to expire unused.

 

53



 

Fiscal 2000 (As Restated) Compared to Fiscal 2001 (As Restated)

Consolidated Results

 

Net sales for fiscal 2001 were $1,276,591, a 23.6% decrease from net sales of $1,670,291 in fiscal 2000.  Wireless Group sales were $978,888 in fiscal year 2001, a 29.8% decrease from sales of $1,393,820 in fiscal 2000.  Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased 21.4% to approximately 7,000,000 units in fiscal 2001 from approximately 8,909,000 units in fiscal 2000.  The average selling price of the Company’s handsets decreased to $127 per unit in fiscal 2001 from $150 per unit in fiscal 2000 due to the introduction of newer digital models and the change of technology from analog to digital.

 

Electronics Group sales were $297,702 in fiscal 2001, an 7.7% increase from sales of $276,471 in fiscal 2000.  This increase was largely due to increased sales in the mobile video and consumer electronics product lines.  Offsetting some of this increase were sound sales, which continue to decline given the change in the marketplace as fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory, rather than being sold in the aftermarket.  This declining trend in sound is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line.  Sales by the Company’s international subsidiaries increased 6.2% in fiscal 2001 to approximately $28.0 million, primarily due to a 41.7% increase in Venezuela due to increasing OEM sales, partially offset by a 17.8% decrease in Malaysia from declining OEM sales.  Sales were impacted by decreased sales incentives of $4,288, primarily in the Wireless Group.  Without this decrease in sales incentives, sales would have decreased 23.3% in 2001 from 2000.

 

Gross profit margin for fiscal 2001 was 5.6%, compared to 7.1% in fiscal 2000.  This decline in profit margin resulted primarily from $20,650 of inventory write-downs to market and margin reductions in Wireless attributable to increased sales of digital products, which have lower margins offset by the reimbursement of $4,550 received from a manufacturer for software upgrades.  A portion of the write-down of $13,500 was related to the analog write-down which was recorded in the second quarter.  A majority of the analog product was sold to customers in Latin America at a price higher than the write-down and had a favorable impact on the Wireless Group’s gross profit for the third quarter.  This improved reported third quarter consolidated margins of 10.8% by 0.6% from 10.2% and 0.8% for the Wireless segment which reported margins 5.9% as compared to 5.1% without the recovery.  Due to specific technical requirements of individual carrier customers, carriers place large purchase commitments for digital handsets with Wireless, which results in a lower selling price which then lowers gross margins.  Consolidated gross margins were also favorably impacted by decreased sales incentives, principally in the Wireless Group, as there were fewer incentive programs.

 

Operating expenses increased $1,630  in fiscal 2001, compared to fiscal 2000.   As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 6.3% in fiscal 2001 from 4.7% in fiscal 2000.  Major components of this increase were professional fees, salaries and commissions.  Operating loss for fiscal 2001 was $9,237, compared to operating income of $39,629 in 2000.

 

During 2000, the Company also recorded an extraordinary gain of $2,189 in connection with the extinguishment of debt.

 

Net loss for fiscal 2001 was $7,198 compared to net income of $27,492 in fiscal 2000.  Loss per share was $(0.33), basic and diluted for fiscal 2001 compared to $1.19, basic, and $1.12, diluted, and $1.29, basic and $1.22, diluted after extraordinary item, in fiscal 2000.

 

54



 

Wireless Results

 

The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of operations data for Wireless expressed as a percentage of net sales:

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

Net sales:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wireless products

 

$

1,359,366

 

97.5

%

$

948,921

 

96.9

%

Activation commissions

 

28,983

 

2.1

 

26,879

 

2.8

 

Residual fees

 

1,852

 

0.1

 

2,396

 

0.2

 

Other

 

3,619

 

0.3

 

692

 

0.1

 

Total net sales

 

1,393,820

 

100.0

 

978,888

 

100.0

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

69,365

 

5.0

 

21,980

 

2.2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

13,609

 

1.0

 

13,108

 

1.3

 

General and administrative

 

15,183

 

1.1

 

16,077

 

1.6

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

2,691

 

0.2

 

2,761

 

0.3

 

Total operating expenses

 

31,483

 

2.3

 

31,946

 

3.2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

 

37,882

 

2.7

 

(9,966

)

(1.0

)

Other expense

 

(7,663

)

(0.5

)

(7,690

)

(0.8

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pre-tax income (loss)

 

$

30,219

 

2.2

%

$

(17,656

)

(1.8

)%

 

Net sales were $978,888 in fiscal 2001, a decrease of $414,932, or 29.8%, from fiscal 2000.  Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased by 1,909,000 units in fiscal 2001, or 21.4%, to approximately 7,000,000 units from 8,909,000 units in fiscal 2000.  This decrease was attributable to decreased sales of both analog and digital handsets which was due to delayed digital product acceptances by our customers, the change in technology from analog to digital and overall slower sales.  The average selling price of handsets decreased to $127 per unit in fiscal 2001 from $150 per unit in fiscal 2000.   During 2000, Wireless adjusted the carrying value of its analog inventory by recording write-downs to market of $8,152.  During 2001, the Company recorded total inventory write-downs to market of $20,650.  During the second quarter of 2001, the Company recorded an additional inventory write down of $13,500 also pertaining to its analog inventory.  (See Consolidated Results, Page 46).  As a result of increasing pricing pressures and a surplus of supply created by other manufacturers also attempting to sell off analog inventories, there was a drop off in demand for analog products during the second quarter.  The write down was based upon the drop in demand, as carriers no longer promoted analog product and notified the Company that previous indications for orders of analog phones were no longer viable, and the continued decline in analog selling prices.  There was a decrease in sales incentives of $5,850 due to lower sales and the changeover to digital products from analog products.

 

During the fourth quarter of 2001, the Company recorded an inventory write-down of $7,150 pertaining

 

55



 

to its digital inventory due to older technology which is to be replaced during fiscal 2002.  This write-down was made based upon open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations.   During the quarter ended November 30, 2001, the Company recorded a reduction to cost of sales of approximately $4,550 for reimbursement from a manufacturer for upgrades performed in 2001 on certain digital phones which partially offset the decline in margins.  Without this reimbursement, gross margins would have been lower by 0.5%.  There were no upgrades performed in 2000.  During 2001 and 2000, Wireless recorded $4,550 and $0 of price protection.  Without this price protection, gross margins would have been lower by 0.5% in 2001.  As of November 30, 2001, the Company had 871,000 units of inventory previously written-down with an extended value, after write-down, of $118,500.  The Company sold all but 3,500 units during fiscal 2002.

 

Operating expenses increased to $31,946 in fiscal 2001 from $31,483 in fiscal 2000.  As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 3.3% during fiscal 2001 compared to 2.3% in fiscal 2000.  Selling expenses decreased $501 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily in advertising of $776 due to discounted advertising costs and reimbursement from various carriers .   This decrease was partially offset by an increase in commissions of $268.  Commissions increased by $268 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001, which was not consistent with the change in sales. This increase was primarily due to a higher analog commission on sales of analog products sold in Mexico.  As analog programs were canceled with the major wireless carriers in the United States, the Company offered a higher commission to sell the analog models quickly.  General and administrative expenses increased $895 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000.  Professional fees increased $1,164 due to litigation expenses.  Office salaries increased by approximately $158, and travel expense increased by approximately $54 during fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily due to increased travel by senior executives and engineers for meetings with overseas vendors regarding new product developments.  The increase in travel expense was offset by a reduction in travel expenses resulting from the closing of certain small Quintex retail locations.  Corporate allocations increased $967 for additional support for the growing business for MIS and computer services.  The increase was offset by a decrease in bad debt expense by $1,317, primarily due to a significant bad debt recorded in fiscal 2000 (one customer that ultimately went out of business) that did not recur to the same extent in 2001.  The Company does not expect the decrease to continue given the volatility in the marketplace and the overall downturn in economic conditions.  Warehousing and technical support expenses increased $70 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily in travel of $105 by our engineering department for product testing and compliance.  Numerous other individually insignificant fluctuations in warehousing and technical support accounted for the remaining net decrease of $35.  Pre-tax loss for fiscal 2001 was $17,656, a decrease of $47,875 from fiscal 2000.

 

Management believes that the wireless industry is extremely competitive and that this competition could affect gross margins and the carrying value of inventories in the future as new competitors enter the marketplace.  This pressure from increased competition is further enhanced by the consolidation of many of Wireless’ customers into a smaller group, dominated by only a few, large customers.  Also, timely delivery and carrier acceptance of new product could affect our quarterly performance.  Our suppliers have to continually add new products in order for Wireless to improve its margins and gain market share.  These new products require extensive testing and software development which could delay entry into the market and affect our sales in the future.  (See Business Overview, page 37.)  In addition, given the anticipated emergence of new technologies in the wireless industry, the Company will need to sell existing inventory quantities of current technologies to avoid further write-downs to market.

 

56



 

Electronics Results

 

The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of income data for the Electronics Group expressed as a percentage of net sales:

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mobile electronics

 

$

134,563

 

48.7

%

$

157,706

 

53.0

%

Sound

 

77,412

 

28.0

 

57,456

 

19.3

 

Consumer electronics

 

60,547

 

21.9

 

80,380

 

27.0

 

Other

 

3,949

 

1.4

 

2,160

 

0.7

 

Total net sales

 

276,471

 

100.0

 

297,702

 

100.0

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

49,960

 

18.1

 

49,088

 

16.5

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

13,114

 

4.8

 

14,449

 

4.9

 

General and administrative

 

17,618

 

6.4

 

19,547

 

6.6

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

639

 

0.2

 

1,134

 

0.3

 

Total operating expenses

 

31,371

 

11.4

 

35,130

 

11.8

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income

 

18,589

 

6.7

 

13,958

 

4.7

 

Other expense

 

(1,937

)

(0.7

)

(178

)

(0.1

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pre-tax income

 

$

16,652

 

6.0

%

$

13,780

 

4.6

%

 

Net sales were $297,702 in fiscal 2001, an 7.7% increase from net sales of $276,471 in fiscal 2000, net of reversals of $1,814 and $1,083 for sales incentive programs in 2001 and 2000, respectively.  Mobile and consumer electronics’ sales increased over last year, partially offset by a decrease in sound.  Mobile electronics increased $23,143 (17.2%) during 2001 from 2000.  Sales of mobile video within the mobile electronics category increased over 27% in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000.  Consumer electronics increased 32.8% to $80,380 in fiscal 2001 from $60,547 in fiscal 2000.  These increases were due to the introduction of new product lines in both categories.  These increases were partially offset by a decrease in the sound category, particularly SPS, AV, private label and Prestige audio lines.  Given the change in the marketplace, fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory rather than being sold in the aftermarket. This declining trend in sound systems is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line.  There was also an increase in sales incentives of $1,562 primarily due to the increase in mobile video sales.

 

Gross profit margins decreased to 16.5% in fiscal 2001 from 18.1% in fiscal 2000, primarily in Prestige Audio and international operations, partially offset by a decrease in AV, Private Label and Security.  During fiscal 2001, there was a decrease in sales incentive expense of $1,814, due to changes in the estimated amount due under accrued sales incentive programs.

 

57



 

Operating expenses increased by $3,759 in fiscal 2001, a 12.0% increase from operating expenses of $31,371 in fiscal 2000.  As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 11.8% during fiscal 2001 compared to 11.3% in fiscal 2000.  Selling expenses increased $1,335 during fiscal 2001, primarily in commissions and advertising.  Commissions increased by approximately $1,266 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001. The increase in commissions was not consistent with the increase in sales due to a change in the mix of consumer goods and mobile video products sold which have varying commission rates.  Advertising and trade show expense increased by approximately $581 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 as more products were sold in the consumer and mobile electronics category which require more advertising to create a demand among end users.  These new products include mobile video, portable DVD’s, navigation systems and mobile security products.  These increases were partially offset by a decrease in salesmen salaries of $578 due to the restructuring of salesmen’s base salaries and the downsizing of some sales offices.  General and administrative expenses increased $1,929 from fiscal 2000, mostly in office salaries, insurance, bad debt, depreciation and amortization.   Office salaries increased approximately $450 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 primarily due to additional employees hired to support the growth of the Electronics business.  Insurance expense increased approximately $248 due to an increase in insurance rates, primarily in ocean cargo and general liability.  Depreciation and amortization expense increased approximately $123 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 as a result of a full year of depreciation on fixed asset additions incurred in the prior year.  Bad debt expense increased by approximately $333 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 due to two specific bad debts that occurred in fiscal 2001 that did not occur in fiscal 2000.  The Company does not expect the increase to continue given that these were two specific customers, with which the Company no longer does business.  Other increases were in professional fees of $105 due to legal expenses and increased corporate allocation of $1,093 for additional support for the growing business.  These increases were partially offset by a decrease in temporary help of $303, as new employees were hired to support the growing business.  Warehousing and technical support expenses increased $495 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily due to direct labor.  Direct labor expense increased by approximately $560 as a result of increased sales.  This was partially offset by a decrease of $62 in engineering department travel.  Pre-tax income for fiscal 2001 was $13,780, a decrease of $2,872 from fiscal 2000.

 

The Company believes that the Electronics Group has an expanding market with a certain level of volatility related to both domestic and international new car sales and general economic conditions.  Also, certain of its products are subject to price fluctuations which could affect the carrying value of inventories and gross margins in the future.

 

Other Income and Expense

 

Interest expense and bank charges decreased $388 during fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily due to decreased interest rates on similar borrowing levels.

 

Equity in income of equity investees increased by approximately $1,014 for fiscal 2001 compared to fiscal 2000.  The majority of the increase was due to increases in the equity income of ASA due to increased sales in the specialized vehicle market.  Other expenses increased as a result of foreign exchange translation in our Venezuelan subsidiary as a result of the devaluation of the Venezuelan currency against the U.S. Dollar (see Note 2(d)).

 

58



 

Provision for Income Taxes

 

The effective tax expense rate for 2000 was 37.4%.  The effective tax benefit rate in 2001 was 31.6%.  The decrease in the effective tax rate is due to the Company having a loss in 2001 for federal purposes combined with state tax expense on certain profitable subsidiaries.

 

59



 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

 

The Company has historically financed its operations primarily through a combination of available borrowings under bank lines of credit and debt and equity offerings.  As of November 30, 2002, the Company had working capital (defined as current assets less current liabilities) of $292,687, which includes cash of $2,758 compared with working capital of $284,166 at November 30, 2001, which includes cash of $3,025.

 

Operating activities provided approximately $24,070 in fiscal 2002 as compared to a cash usage of $74,076 in fiscal 2001, primarily from a decrease in accounts receivable of $48,555 due to lower sales and better cash collections, an increase in accounts payable, accrued expenses and other current liabilities due to new trade terms from vendor, offset by an increase in inventory due to cancellation of certain orders in the Electronics Group and new products in Wireless slated for shipment in 2003.

 

Investing activities provided approximately $20,090, primarily from proceeds from the issuance of subsidiary shares, partially offset by the purchase of certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc.

 

Financing activities used approximately $44,198, primarily for repayments to bank institutions.

 

The Company’s Board of Directors approved the repurchase of 1,563,000 shares of the Company’s Class A common stock in the open market under a share repurchase program (the Program).  As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, 909,537 and 1,072,737 shares, respectively, were repurchased under the Program at an average price of $8.12 and $7.93 per share, respectively, for an aggregate amount of $7,386 and $8,511, respectively.

 

In February 2000, the Company completed a follow on offering of 3,565,000 Class A common shares at a price to the public of $45.00 per share.  Of the 3,565,000 shares sold, the Company offered 2,300,000 shares and 1,265,000 shares were offered by selling shareholders.  Audiovox received approximately $96,573 after deducting expenses.  The Company used these net proceeds to repay a portion of amounts outstanding under their revolving credit facility, any portion of which can be reborrowed at any time.  The Company did not receive any of the net proceeds from the sale of shares by the selling shareholders.

 

The Company’s principal source of liquidity is its revolving credit agreement which expires July 27, 2004 and cash flows from operations.  Subsequent to year-end, the Company requested a reduction of available credit from $250,000 to $200,000.  This is a result of excess bank availability being reduced to limit paid fees on unused portions of bank availability.  The credit agreement was amended on March 13, 2003 and provides for $200,000 of available credit, including $15,000 for foreign currency borrowings. The continued availability of this financing is dependent upon the Company’s operating results and borrowing base which would be negatively impacted by a decrease in demand for the Company’s products.

 

Under the credit agreement, the Company may obtain credit through direct borrowings and letters of credit.  The obligations of the Company under the credit agreement are guaranteed by certain of the Company’s subsidiaries and is secured by accounts receivable and inventory.  As of November 30, 2002, availability under this line of credit is subject to certain conditions, based upon a formula taking into account the amount and quality of its accounts receivable and inventory.  At November 30, 2002, the amount of unused available credit is $102,491.  The credit agreement also allows for commitments up to $50,000 in forward exchange

 

60



 

contracts.  In addition, the Company guarantees the borrowings of one of its equity investees at a maximum of $300.

 

The credit agreement contains several covenants requiring, among other things, minimum levels of pre-tax income and minimum levels of net worth. Additionally, the agreement includes restrictions and limitations on payments of dividends, stock repurchases and capital expenditures.

 

At May 31, 2001, November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, the Company was not in compliance with certain of its pre-tax income covenants.  Furthermore, as of November 30, 2002, the Company was also not in compliance with the requirement to deliver audited financial statements 90 days after the Company’s fiscal year-end, and as of February 28, 2003, the requirement to deliver unaudited quarterly financial statements 45 days after the Company’s quarter end.  The Company received a waiver for the November 30, 2001 pre-tax income violation subsequent to its issuance of the November 30, 2001 financial statements. In addition, the Company received waivers for the May 31, 2001 and February 28, 2002 violations.

 

The Company has not received waivers for the November 30, 2002 violation of a particular pre-tax income covenant or delivery of audited financial statements 90 days after the Company’s fiscal year-end.  Accordingly, as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company’s outstanding domestic obligations of $86,525 and 36,883, have been classified as current on the accompanying consolidated financial statements, respectively.  Management is in the process of requesting a waiver for the November 30, 2002 and February 28, 2003 violations.  While the Company was able to obtain waivers for such violations in 2001 and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, there can be no assurance that future negotiations with its lenders would be successful or that the Company will not violate covenants in the future, therefore, resulting in amounts outstanding to be payable upon demand.  Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company repaid its obligation of $36,883 in full resulting in bank obligations outstanding at May 15, 2003 of $0.  This credit agreement has no cross covenants with the other credit facilities described below.

 

The Company also has revolving credit facilities in Malaysia to finance additional working capital needs.  As of November 30, 2002, the available line of credit for direct borrowing, letters of credit, bankers’ acceptances and other forms of credit approximately $5,000.  The Malaysian credit facilities are partially secured by the Company under three standby letters of credit of $1,300, $800 and $800 and are payable on demand or upon expiration of the standby letters of credit which expire on December 31, 2002, August 31, 2003 and August 31, 2003, respectively.   The obligations of the Company under the Malaysian credit facilities are secured by the property and building in Malaysia owned by Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd.

 

The Company also has a revolving credit facility in Brazil to finance additional working capital needs. The Brazilian credit facility is secured by the Company under a standby letter of credit in the amount of $200, which expires on January 15, 2003 and is payable on demand or upon expiration of the standby letter of credit.  At November 30, 2002, outstanding obligations under the credit facility were 172 Brazilian Bolivars ($47), and interest on the credit facility ranged from 19% to 29%.

 

Total debt as a percent of total capitalization was 20% at November 30, 2002 as compared with 33% at November 30, 2001, primarily as a result of lower outstanding indebtedness.

 

61



 

At November 30, 2002, the Company had additional outstanding standby letters of credit aggregating $640 which expire in July 2004.

 

The Company has certain contractual cash obligations and other commercial commitments which will impact its short and long-term liquidity. At November 30, 2002, such obligations and commitments are as follows:

 

 

 

Payments Due By Period

 

Contractual Cash Obligations

 

Total

 

Less than
1 Year

 

1-3 Years

 

4-5 Years

 

Over
5 Years

 

Capital lease obligations

 

$

14,206

 

$

554

 

$

1,666

 

$

1,157

 

$

10,829

 

Operating leases

 

6,680

 

1,983

 

2,359

 

1,449

 

889

 

Total contractual cash obligations

 

$

20,886

 

$

2,537

 

$

4,025

 

$

2,606

 

$

11,718

 

 

 

 

Amount of Commitment
Expiration per period

 

Other Commercial
Commitments

 

Total
Amounts
Committed

 

Less than
1 Year

 

1-3 Years

 

4-5 Years

 

Over
5 years

 

Lines of credit

 

$

40,248

 

$

40,248

 

 

 

 

Standby letters of credit

 

3,740

 

3,740

 

 

 

 

Guarantees

 

300

 

300

 

 

 

 

Commercial letters of credit

 

8,129

 

8,129

 

 

 

 

Total commercial commitments

 

$

52,417

 

$

52,417

 

 

 

 

 

The Company regularly reviews its cash funding requirements and attempts to meet those requirements through a combination of cash on hand, cash provided by operations, available borrowings under bank lines of credit and possible future public or private debt and/or equity offerings.  At times, the Company evaluates possible acquisitions of, or investments in, businesses that are complementary to those of the Company, which transaction may require the use of cash. The Company believes that its cash, other liquid assets, operating cash flows, credit arrangements, access to equity capital markets, taken together, provide adequate resources to fund ongoing operating expenditures.  In the event that they do not, the Company may require additional funds in the future to support its working capital requirements or for other purposes and may seek to raise such additional funds through the sale of public or private equity and/or debt financings as well as from other sources.  No assurance can be given that additional financing will be available in the future or that if available, such financing will be obtainable on terms favorable to the Company when required.

 

In February 2003, the Company entered into an agreement to buy a building for expansion purposes

 

62



 

for $3,480, made a deposit of $348 and expects to close in the very near term.

 

In May 2003, the Company entered into an asset purchase agreement to buy certain assets of Recoton Corporation.  In accordance with the agreement, the Company made a deposit of $2,000, which is currently being held in escrow.  The Company is awaiting final approval of this purchase from a bankruptcy court.  This purchase would amount to approximately $40,000 plus the assumption of $5,000 in debt, not including related acquisition costs. The Company anticipates using its existing cash and available financing to fund this acquisition.

 

Related Party Transactions

 

The Company has entered into several related party transactions which are described below.

 

Leasing Transactions

 

During 1998, the Company entered into a 30-year capital lease for a building with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer, which is the headquarters of the Wireless operation.  Payments on the lease were based upon the construction costs of the building and the then-current interest rates.  The effective interest rate on the capital lease obligation is 8%.   In connection with the capital lease, the Company paid certain costs on behalf of its principal  stockholder and chief executive officer in the amount of $1,301.  The advance does not have a specified due date or interest rate.  During 2001 and 2002, the entire balance of $1,301 was repaid to the Company.

 

During 1998, the Company entered into a sale/leaseback transaction with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer for $2,100 of equipment, which has been classified as an operating lease.  The lease is a five-year lease with monthly payments of $34.  No gain or loss was recorded on the transaction as the book value of the equipment equaled the fair market value.

 

The Company also leases certain facilities from its principal stockholder. Rentals for such leases are considered by management of the Company to approximate prevailing market rates. Total lease payments required under the leases for the five-year period ending November 30, 2007 are $2,739.

 

Amounts Due from Officers

 

A note due from an officer/director of the Company, which bore interest at the LIBOR rate, to be adjusted quarterly, plus 1.25% per annum, was paid in full during fiscal 2002.  In addition, the Company has outstanding notes due from various officers of the Company aggregating $235 as of November 30, 2002, which have been included in prepaid expenses and other current assets on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet.  The notes bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus 0.5% per annum.  Principal and interest are payable in equal annual installments beginning July 1, 1999 through July 1, 2003.  In accordance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the Company will not alter the terms of the notes and all amounts will be repaid in full in July 2003.  In addition, no new notes with officers or directors of the Company will be entered into.

 

Transactions with Shintom and TALK

 

In April 2000, AX Japan purchased land and a building (the Property) from Shintom Co., Ltd.

 

63



 

(Shintom) for 770,000,000 Yen (approximately $7,300) and entered into a leaseback agreement whereby Shintom has leased the Property from AX Japan for a one-year period.  This lease is being accounted for as an operating lease by AX Japan. Shintom is a stockholder who owns all of the outstanding preferred stock of the Company and is a manufacturer of products purchased by the Company through its previously-owned equity investment, TALK Corporation (TALK).  The Company currently holds stock in Shintom and has previously invested in Shintom convertible debentures.

 

64



 

The purchase of the Property by AX Japan was financed with a 500,000,000 Yen ($4,671) subordinated loan obtained from Vitec Co., Ltd.  (Vitec), a 150,000,000 Yen loan ($1,397) from Pearl First (Pearl) and a 140,000,000 Yen loan ($1,291) from the Company.  The land and building have been included in property, plant and equipment, and the loans have been recorded as notes payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002 .  Vitec is a major supplier to Shintom, and Pearl is an affiliate of Vitec.  The loans bear interest at 5% per annum, and principle is payable in equal monthly installments over a six-month period beginning six months subsequent to the date of the loans.  The loans from Vitec and Pearl are subordinated completely to the loan from the Company and, in liquidation, the Company receives payment first.

 

Upon the expiration of six months after the transfer of the title to the Property to AX Japan, Shintom has the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan.  These options can be extended for one additional six month period.  The option to repurchase the building is at a price of 770,000,000 Yen plus the equity capital of AX Japan (which in no event can be less than 60,000,000 Yen) and can only be made if Shintom settles any rent due AX Japan pursuant to the lease agreement.  The option to purchase the shares of stock of AX Japan is at a price not less than the aggregate par value of the shares and, subsequent to the purchase of the shares, AX Japan must repay the outstanding loan due to the Company.  If Shintom does not exercise its option to repurchase the Property or the shares of AX Japan, or upon occurrence of certain events, AX Japan can dispose of the Property as it deems appropriate.  The events which result in the ability of AX Japan to be able to dispose of the Property include Shintom petitioning for bankruptcy, failing to honor a check, failing to pay rent, etc.  If Shintom fails, or at any time becomes financially or otherwise unable to exercise its option to repurchase the Property, Vitec has the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan under similar terms as the Shintom options.

 

In connection with this transaction, the Company received 100,000,000 Yen ($922) from Shintom for its 2,000 shares of TALK stock.  The Company had the option to repurchase the shares of TALK at a purchase price of 50,000 Yen per share, with no expiration date.  Given the option to repurchase the shares of TALK, the Company did not surrender control over the shares of TALK and, accordingly, had not accounted for this transaction as a sale.  In August 2000, the Company surrendered its option to repurchase the shares of TALK.  As such, the Company recorded a gain on the sale of shares in the amount of $427 in August 2000.

 

AX Japan had the option to delay the repayment of the loans for an additional six months if Shintom extended its options to repurchase the Property or stock of AX Japan.  In September 2000, Shintom extended its option to repurchase the Property and AX Japan delayed its repayment of the loans for an additional six months.

 

In October 2002, the Company sold all of its shares in AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., an unrelated party to the Company.  The purchase price of the shares was 60,000 Yen.  As a result of this transaction, the purchaser repaid in full 113,563 Yen which represented the full balance of amounts then owed to the Company by AX Japan.  The agreement required the purchaser to immediately change the name of AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., and the Company resigned from all officer and Board of Directors  positions.  The Company has no further relationship or obligations, whether contingent or direct, to RMS Co., Ltd., formerly known as AX Japan.

 

65



 

As a result of  the completion of this transaction, all assets and liabilities of Audiovox Japan have been removed from the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002, specifically, the land and the building and the notes payable for the Vitec Co., Ltd (Vitec) 150,000 Yen loan and the Pearl First (Pearl) a 140,000 Yen loan. As a result of this transaction, the Company recovered in Yen its initial investment in AX Japan as well as its loan to finance the purchase of the land and building.  However, the Company recognized a $338 loss on the sale of its shares in AX Japan, as the sales price was less than the value of the net assets of AX Japan sold to Vitec.  Contributing to the loss on sale were foreign currency loss and other expenses that will not be recovered.  The loss on the sale of the shares of AX Japan has been included in other net on the accompanying consolidated statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002.

 

The Company engages in transactions with Shintom and TALK. TALK, which holds world-wide distribution rights for product manufactured by Shintom, has given the Company exclusive distribution rights on all wireless personal communication products for all countries except Japan, China, Thailand and several mid-eastern countries.  Through October 2000, the Company  held a 30.8% interest in TALK.  The Company no longer holds an equity interest in TALK.

 

Transactions with Shintom and TALK include financing arrangements and inventory purchases which approximated 7%, 1.5% and 0.7% for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively, of total inventory purchases.  At November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had recorded $1, $331  and $0, respectively, of liability due to TALK for inventory purchases included in accounts payable.  There were no documentary acceptance obligations payable to TALK as of  November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002.  At November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had recorded a receivable from TALK in the amount of $3,823, $265 and $13, respectively,  a portion of which is payable with interest, which is reflected in receivable from vendors on the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  During 2002, the Company recorded an impairment charge of $1,158 on the 634,666 shares owned at November 30, 2002.

 

Transactions with Toshiba

 

On March 31, 1999, Toshiba purchased 5% of the Company’s subsidiary, ACC, a supplier of wireless products for $5,000 in cash.  The Company then owned 95% of ACC; prior to the transaction ACC was a wholly-owned subsidiary.  In February 2001, the Board of Directors of ACC, declared a dividend payable to its shareholders, Audiovox Corporation, a then 95% shareholder, and Toshiba, a then 5% shareholder.  ACC paid Toshiba its share of the dividend, which approximated $1,034 in the first quarter of 2001.  The dividend equaled 5.0% of ACC’s prior year net income.  There were no dividends declared during 2002, due to the net loss of ACC during 2001.  During the second quarter of 2002, Toshiba purchased an additional 20% of ACC.  Under the terms of the transaction, Toshiba acquired, in exchange for $23,900 cash,  the additional shares of ACC.  In addition, Toshiba paid $8,100 in exchange for an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note) due from ACC.  The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1¾% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003.  The unpaid principal amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest on May 31, 2007 which will automatically renew for an additional five years.  In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may, at any time, convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a 25% maximum interest in ACC.   The cost per share of the note is equal to the per share cost for the $23,900 cash payment of 20% of ACC’s

 

66



 

shares.  In connection with the transaction, ACC and Toshiba entered into a distribution agreement whereby ACC will be Toshiba’s exclusive distributor for the sale of Toshiba products in the United States, Canada, Mexico and all countries in the Caribbean and Central and South America through May 29, 2007.  The distribution agreement established certain annual minimum purchase targets for ACC’s purchase of Toshiba products for each fiscal year during the entire term of the agreement.  In the event that ACC fails to meet the minimum purchase target, Toshiba shall have the right to convert ACC’s exclusive distributorship to a non-exclusive distributorship for the remaining term of the agreement.  Also, in accordance with the terms of the stockholders agreement, upon the termination of the distribution agreement in accordance with certain terms of the distribution agreement, Toshiba maintains a put right and Audiovox Corp. a call right, to repurchase all of the shares held by the other party for a price equal to the fair market value of the shares as calculated in accordance with the agreement. Pursuant to the agreement, the put right is only exercisable if ACC terminates the distribution agreement or if another strategic investor acquires a direct or indirect equity ownership interest in excess of 20% in the Company. The call right is only exercisable if Toshiba elects to terminate the distribution agreement after its initial five (5) year term.

 

Additionally in connection with the transaction, ACC entered into an employment agreement with the President and Chief Executive Officer (the Executive) of ACC through May 29, 2007.  Under the agreement, ACC is required to pay the Executive an annual base salary of $500 in addition to an annual bonus equal to 2% of ACC’s annual earnings before income taxes.  Audiovox Corp., under the employment agreement, was required to establish and pay a bonus of $3,200 to key employees of ACC, including the Executive, to be allocated by the Executive.  The bonus was for services previously rendered in connection with the Toshiba purchase of additional shares of ACC, and, accordingly, the bonus has been included in general and administrative expenses in the accompanying statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002.  The Executive was required to utilize all or a portion of the bonus allocated to him to repay the remaining outstanding principal and accrued interest owed by the Executive to the Company pursuant to the unsecured promissory note in favor of Audiovox Corp.  During the year ended November 30, 2002, the Executive was paid $1,800 less the amount outstanding under the promissory note of $651.

 

As a result of the issuance of ACC’s shares, the Company recognized a gain, net of expenses of $1,735, of $14,269 ($8,847 after provision for deferred taxes).  The gain on the issuance of the subsidiary’s shares has been recognized in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations.

 

Inventory on hand at November 30, 2001 and November 30, 2002 purchased from Toshiba approximated $99,816 and $138,467, respectively. During the quarter ended November 30, 2001, the Company recorded a receivable in the amount of $4,550 from Toshiba for upgrades that were performed by the Company in 2001 on certain models which Toshiba manufactured. The amount was received in full during the first quarter of 2002.  At November 30, 2002, the Company recorded receivables from Toshiba aggregating approximately $12,219 for price protection and software upgrades.  Subsequent to November 30, 2002, these amounts were paid in full.

 

At November 30, 2002, the Company had on hand 504,020 units in the amount of $91,226, which were purchased from Toshiba and have been recorded in inventory and accounts payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet.  Of this accounts payable, $56,417 was subject to an arrangement with Toshiba, which provides for, among other things, extended payment terms.  This arrangement has since been modified in an effort to enhance the Company’s relationship with Toshiba.  The payment terms are such that the payable

 

67



 

is non-interest bearing.  The remaining 34,809 of the $91,226 accounts payable is payable in accordance with the terms established in the distribution agreement, which is 30 days.  Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company paid this amount in full.  Under the above arrangement, the Company is entitled to receive price protection in the event the selling price to its customers is less than the purchase price from Toshiba.  The Company will record such price protection, if necessary, at the time of the sale of the units.   The Company had no other amounts outstanding to Toshiba at November 30, 2002.

 

Impact of Inflation and Currency Fluctuation

 

Inflation has not had a significant impact on the Company’s financial position or operating results other than the effect of our 80%-owned Venezuelan subsidiary ceasing to be considered a highly-inflationary economy in fiscal 2002. To the extent that the Company expands its operations into Latin America and the Pacific Rim, the effects of inflation and currency fluctuations in those areas could have growing significance to its  financial condition and results of operations. Fluctuations in the foreign exchange rates in Pacific Rim countries have not had a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

 

While the prices that the Company pays for the products purchased from its suppliers are principally denominated in United States dollars, price negotiations depend in part on the relationship between the foreign currency of the foreign manufacturers and the United States dollar. This relationship is dependent upon, among other things, market, trade and political factors.

 

Inflation-related accounting adjustments of $333 were made for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2001, related to the Company’s operations in Venezuela.  Inflation-related accounting adjustments of $1,712 were made for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002 related to the Company’s operations in Venezuela.  This increase is a result of Venezuela no longer being deemed a hyper-inflationary economy as of the first quarter of fiscal 2002.  On January 22, 2003, and as a result of the National Civil Strike, the Venezuelan government suspended trading of the Venezuelan Bolivar and set the currency at a stated government rate.  Accordingly, until further guidance is issued, the Company’s 80% owned Venezuelan subsidiary will translate its financial statements utilizing the stated government rate.

 

Seasonality

 

The Company typically experiences some seasonality in its operations. The Company generally experiences a substantial amount of its sales during September, October and November. December is also a key month for the Company due to increased demand for its products during the holiday season. This increase results from increased promotional and advertising activities from the Company’s customers to end-users.

 

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

 

In July 2001, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 141, “Business Combinations” and SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”.  SFAS No. 141 requires that the purchase method of accounting be used for all future business combinations and specifies criteria intangible assets acquired in a business combination must meet to be recognized and reported apart from goodwill.  SFAS No. 142 requires that goodwill and intangible assets

 

68



 

with indefinite useful lives no longer be amortized, but instead be tested for impairment at least annually in accordance with the provisions of SFAS No. 142.  SFAS No. 142 also requires that intangible assets with estimable useful lives be amortized over their respective estimated useful lives and reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 121, “Accounting for the impairment of Long-Live Assets to be Disposed Of”.

 

The Company early adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and SFAS No. 142 as of December 1, 2001.  As a result of adopting the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and 142, the Company did not record amortization expense relating to its goodwill during the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002, which approximated $9,616.  The Company was not required under SFAS No. 142 to assess the useful life and residual value of its goodwill as the Company’s goodwill is equity method goodwill and, as such, will continue to be evaluated for impairment under SFAS No. 121, “Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed Of.”

 

In July 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 143, “Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations” (Statement 143).  Statement 143 is effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 2002, and establishes an accounting standard requiring the recording of the fair value of liabilities associated with the retirement of long-lived assets in the period in which they are incurred.  The Company does not expect the adoption of Statement 143 to have a significant effect on its results of operations or its financial position.

 

In October 2001, the FASB issued SFAS  No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” (Statement 144), which addresses financial accounting and reporting for the impairment or disposal of long-lived assets.  This statement supersedes Statement No. 121, “Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of”, while retaining the fundamental recognition and measurement provisions of that statement.  Statement No. 144 requires that a long-lived asset to be abandoned, exchanged for a similar productive asset or distributed to owners in a spin-off to be considered held and used until it is disposed of.  However, Statement No. 144 requires that management consider revising the depreciable life of such long-lived asset.  With respect to long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale, Statement No. 144 retains the provisions of Statement No. 121 and, therefore, requires that discontinued operations no longer be measured on a net realizable value basis and that future operating losses associated with such discontinued operations no longer be recognized before they occur.  Statement No. 144 is effective for all fiscal quarters of fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2001 and will thus be adopted by the Company on December 1, 2002.  The Company has determined that the effect of the adoption of Statement No. 144 did not have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

SFAS 145 “Rescission of SFAS Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of SFAS No. 13 and Technical Corrections”.  This Statement updates, clarifies and simplifies existing accounting pronouncements by rescinding Statement 4, which required all gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated and, if material, classified as an extraordinary item, net of related income tax effect.  As a result, the criteria in Opinion 30 will now be used to classify those gains and losses. This statement will have no material effect on the Company’s financial statements.

 

Effective March 1, 2002, the Company adopted Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 01-9, “Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer”, which codified and reconciled the following EITF Issues: Issue No. 00-14, “Accounting for Certain Sales Incentive”, Issue No. 00-22,

 

69



 

“Accounting for Points and Certain Other Time-Based Sales Incentive Offers and Offers for Free Products or Services to be Delivered in the Future” and Issue No. 00-25, “Vendor Income Statement Characterization of Consideration Paid to a Reseller of the Vendor’s Products”. Issue No. 00-14 addressed when sales incentives and discounts should be recognized, as well as where the related revenues and expenses should be classified in the financial statements.  Upon adoption of this Issue, the Company reclassified its sales incentives which take the form of  (co-operative advertising allowances, market development funds, volume incentive rebates and other trade allowances) against net sales which were previously recorded in selling expenses.  Operating income has remained unchanged by this adoption.  These reclassifications have been reported in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations retroactively for all periods reported.

 

70



 

In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 148, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation - Transition and Disclosure”.  SFAS No. 148 provides alternative methods of transition for a voluntary change to the fair value method of accounting for stock-based employee compensation as originally provided by SFAS No. 123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation”.  Additionally, SFAS No. 148 amends the disclosure requirements of SFAS No. 123 to require prominent disclosure in both annual and interim financial statements about the method of accounting for stock-based compensation and the effect of the method used on reported results.  The transitional requirements of SFAS No. 148 will be effective for all financial statements for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2002.  The disclosure requirements shall be effective for financial reports containing condensed financial statements for interim periods beginning after December 31, 2002.  The Company expects to adopt the disclosure portion of this statement for the fiscal quarter ending May 31, 2003.  The application of this standard will have no impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

In February 2003, the EITF Issued 02-16, “Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for Certain Consideration Received from a Vendor”. This EITF provides guidance on the income statement classification of amounts received by a customer, including a reseller and guidance regarding timing of recognition for volume rebates.  The Company does not believe that adoption of this new standard, which will be applied prospectively by the Company for new arrangements, including modifications of existing arrangements, entered into after December 31, 2002, will have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

In November 2002, the FASB issued Interpretation No.  45 (FIN 45), “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantors, Including Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others”.  FIN 45 elaborates on the disclosures to be made by a guarantor in its interim and annual financial statements about its obligations under certain guarantees that it has issued.  It also clarifies that a guarantor is required to recognize, at the inception of a guarantee, a liability for the fair value of the obligation undertaken in issuing the guarantee.  The initial recognition and initial measurement provisions of FIN 45 are applicable on a prospective basis to guarantees issued or modified after December 31, 2002, irrespective of the guarantor’s fiscal year-end.  The disclosure requirements of FIN 45 are effective for financial statements of interim or annual periods ending after December 15, 2002.  The Company does not expect the adoption of FIN 45 to have a material effect on its consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

In January 2003, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, an interpretation of ARB No. 51”.  FIN 46 addresses the consolidation by business enterprises of variable interest entities as defined in the Interpretation.  FIN 46 is effective for all new variable interest entities created or acquired after January 31, 2003.  For variable interest entities created or acquired prior to February 1, 2003, the provisions of FIN 46 must be applied for the first interim period beginning after June 15, 2003. The adoption of FIN46 is being evaluated to determine what impact, if any, the adoption of the provisions will have on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

 

Item 7a - Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

 

Market Risk Sensitive Instruments

 

The  market risk inherent in the Company’s market risk sensitive instruments and positions is the

 

71



 

potential loss arising from adverse changes in marketable equity security prices, foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates.

 

Marketable Securities

 

Marketable securities at November 30, 2002, which are recorded at fair value of $5,405 and include net unrealized losses of $966, have exposure to price risk. This risk is estimated as the potential loss in fair value resulting from a hypothetical 10% adverse change in prices quoted by stock exchanges and amounts to $541 as of November 30, 2002.  Actual results may differ.

 

Interest Rate Risk

 

The Company’s bank loans expose earnings to changes in short-term interest rates since interest rates on the underlying obligations are either variable or fixed for such a short period of time as to effectively become variable.  The fair values of the Company’s bank loans are not significantly affected by changes in market interest rates.

 

Foreign Exchange Risk

 

In order to reduce the risk of foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations, the Company hedges transactions denominated in a currency other than the functional currencies applicable to each of its various entities. The instruments used for hedging are forward contracts with banks.  The changes in market value of such contracts have a high correlation to price changes in the currency of the related hedged transactions.  There were no hedge transactions at November 30, 2002.  Intercompany transactions with foreign subsidiaries and equity investments are typically not hedged. Therefore, the potential loss in fair value for a net currency position resulting from a  10% adverse change in quoted foreign currency exchange rates as of November 30, 2002 is not applicable.

 

The Company is subject to risk from changes in foreign exchange rates for its subsidiaries and equity investments that use a foreign currency as their functional currency and are translated into U.S. dollars. These changes result in cumulative translation adjustments which are included in accumulated other comprehensive income. On November 30, 2002, the Company had translation exposure to various foreign currencies with the most significant being the Malaysian ringgit, Thailand baht and Canadian dollar. The Company also has a Venezuelan subsidiary in which translation adjustments are included in net income. The potential loss resulting from a hypothetical 10% adverse change in quoted foreign currency exchange rates, as of November 30, 2002, amounts to $867. Actual results may differ.

 

Item 8 - Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

 

The consolidated financial statements of the Company as of November 30, 2001 and 2002 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002, together with the independent auditors’ report thereon of KPMG LLP, independent auditors, are filed under this Item 8.

 

The consolidated financial statements as of and for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2000 have been restated as described in Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

72



 

Independent Auditors’ Report

 

 

The Board of Directors and Stockholders

Audiovox Corporation:

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries as of  November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of  the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

 

As discussed in Note 1, effective December 1, 2001, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (Statement) No. 141, “Business Combinations” and Statement No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”.

 

As discussed in Note 2 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements, the consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity  and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 have been restated.

 

 

 

s/KPMG LLP

 

 

KPMG  LLP

 

Melville, New York

May 30, 2003

 

73



 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Balance Sheets

November 30, 2001 and 2002

(In thousands, except share data)

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated
See Note (2)

 

 

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets:

 

 

 

 

 

Cash

 

$

3,025

 

$

2,758

 

Accounts receivable, net

 

238,357

 

186,564

 

Inventory, net

 

225,759

 

290,064

 

Receivable from vendor

 

6,828

 

14,174

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

7,639

 

7,626

 

Deferred income taxes, net

 

11,965

 

7,653

 

Total current assets

 

493,573

 

508,839

 

Investment securities

 

5,777

 

5,405

 

Equity investments

 

10,268

 

11,097

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

25,687

 

18,381

 

Excess cost over fair value of assets acquired and other intangible assets, net

 

4,742

 

6,826

 

Deferred income taxes, net

 

3,148

 

 

Other assets

 

1,302

 

687

 

 

 

$

544,497

 

$

551,235

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

$

57,162

 

$

121,127

 

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

 

42,137

 

34,983

 

Accrued sales incentives

 

8,474

 

12,151

 

Income taxes payable

 

4,154

 

7,643

 

Bank obligations

 

92,213

 

40,248

 

Notes payable

 

5,267

 

 

Total current liabilities

 

209,407

 

216,152

 

Long-term debt

 

 

8,140

 

Capital lease obligation

 

6,196

 

6,141

 

Deferred income taxes payable

 

 

2,704

 

Deferred compensation

 

3,844

 

3,969

 

Total liabilities

 

219,447

 

237,106

 

Minority interest

 

1,830

 

4,616

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock, liquidation preference of $2,500

 

2,500

 

2,500

 

Common stock:

 

 

 

 

 

Class A; 60,000,000 authorized 2001 and 2002, 20,615,846 and 20,632,182 issued 2001 and 2002, respectively; 19,706,309 and 19,559,445 outstanding 2001 and 2002, respectively

 

207

 

207

 

Class B convertible; 10,000,000 authorized; 2,260,954 issued and outstanding

 

22

 

22

 

Paid-in capital

 

250,785

 

250,917

 

Retained earnings

 

83,436

 

69,396

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

(6,344

)

(5,018

)

Treasury stock, at cost, 909,537 and 1,072,737 Class A common stock 2001 and 2002, respectively

 

(7,386

)

(8,511

)

Total stockholders’ equity

 

323,220

 

309,513

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

 

$

544,497

 

$

551,235

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

74



 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Operations

Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated
See Note (2)

 

As Restated
See Note (2)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

1,670,291

 

$

1,276,591

 

$

1,100,382

 

Cost of sales

 

1,551,666

 

1,205,201

 

1,025,783

 

Gross profit

 

118,625

 

71,390

 

74,599

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

29,056

 

30,039

 

29,509

 

General and administrative

 

46,466

 

46,505

 

55,292

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

3,474

 

4,082

 

3,874

 

Total operating expenses

 

78,996

 

80,626

 

88,675

 

Operating income (loss)

 

39,629

 

(9,236

)

(14,076

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest and bank charges

 

(6,310

)

(5,922

)

(4,219

)

Equity in income of equity investees

 

2,572

 

3,586

 

1,779

 

Gain on sale of investments

 

2,387

 

 

 

Gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities

 

1,499

 

 

 

Gain on issuance of subsidiary shares

 

 

 

14,269

 

Other, net

 

2,366

 

90

 

(4,156

)

Total other income (expense), net

 

2,514

 

(2,246

)

7,673

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest, extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

42,143

 

(11,482

)

(6,403

)

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

15,766

 

(3,627

)

12,932

 

Minority interest

 

(1,074

)

657

 

5,055

 

Income (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

25,303

 

(7,198

)

(14,280

)

Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt

 

2,189

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

 

 

240

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

27,492

 

$

(7,198

)

$

(14,040

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

$

1.19

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.65

)

Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt

 

0.10

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

 

 

0.01

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic)

 

$

1.29

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.64

)

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

$

1.12

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.65

)

Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt

 

0.10

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

 

 

0.01

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted)

 

$

1.22

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.64

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,393,566

 

21,877,100

 

21,850,035

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

22,565,806

 

21,877,100

 

21,850,035

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

75



 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity and Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002

(In thousands, except share data)

 

 

 

Preferred
Stock

 

Common
Stock

 

Paid-In
Capital

 

Retained
Earnings

 

Accum-
ulated
Other
Compre-
hensive
Income
(Loss)

 

Gain on
Hedge of
Available
for Sale
Securities

 

Treasury
Stock

 

Total Stock-
holders’
Equity

 

Balances at November 30, 1999

 

2,500

 

201

 

149,278

 

63,142

 

5,165

 

929

 

(4,471

)

216,744

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Comprehensive income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income, as restated

 

 

 

 

27,492

 

 

 

 

27,492

 

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

(104

)

 

 

(104

)

Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $(6,202)

 

 

 

 

 

(10,119

)

 

 

(10,119

)

Other comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(10,223

)

Comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

17,269

 

Exercise of stock options into 121,300 shares of common stock and issuance of 11,671 shares under the Restricted Stock Plan

 

 

1

 

836

 

 

 

 

 

837

 

Tax benefit of stock options exercised

 

 

 

1,270

 

 

 

 

 

1,270

 

Conversion of debentures into 30,170 shares

 

 

1

 

534

 

 

 

 

 

535

 

Issuance of 2,300,000 shares in connection with stock offering

 

 

23

 

96,550

 

 

 

 

 

96,573

 

Acquisition of 141,455 common shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1,533

)

(1,533

)

Recognition of gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

(929

)

 

(929

)

Balances at November 30, 2000, as restated

 

2,500

 

226

 

248,468

 

90,634

 

(5,058

)

 

(6,004

)

330,766

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss, as restated

 

 

 

 

(7,198

)

 

 

 

(7,198

)

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

(455

)

 

 

(455

)

Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $(509)

 

 

 

 

 

(831

)

 

 

(831

)

Other comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1,286

)

Comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(8,484

)

Exercise of stock options into 10,000 shares of common stock

 

 

 

77

 

 

 

 

 

77

 

Conversion of stock warrants into 314,800 shares

 

 

3

 

2,240

 

 

 

 

 

2,243

 

Acquisition of 147,045 common shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1,382

)

(1,382

)

Balances at November 30, 2001, as restated

 

2,500

 

229

 

250,785

 

83,436

 

(6,344

)

 

(7,386

)

323,220

 

Comprehensive loss:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

 

 

 

(14,040

)

 

 

 

(14,040

)

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

904

 

 

 

904

 

Unrealized gain on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $260

 

 

 

 

 

422

 

 

 

422

 

Other comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,326

 

Comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(12,714

)

Exercise of stock options into 16,336 shares of common stock

 

 

 

132

 

 

 

 

 

132

 

Acquisition of 163,200 common shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1,125

)

(1,125

)

Balances at November 30, 2002

 

2,500

 

229

 

250,917

 

69,396

 

(5,018

)

 

(8,511

)

309,513

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

76



 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002

(In thousands)

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated
See Note (2)

 

As Restated
See Note (2)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

27,492

 

$

(7,198

)

$

(14,040

)

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash flows (used in) provided by operating activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

4,128

 

4,476

 

4,780

 

Provision for bad debt expense

 

2,519

 

1,936

 

4,884

 

Equity in income of equity investments

 

(2,572

)

(3,586

)

(1,779

)

Minority interest

 

1,074

 

(657

)

(5,055

)

Gain on sale of investments

 

(427

)

 

 

Gain from the sale of shares of equity investment

 

(2,387

)

 

 

Gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities

 

(1,499

)

 

 

Gain on issuance of subsidiary shares

 

 

 

(14,269

)

Other-than-temporary decline in market value of investment security

 

 

 

1,158

 

Deferred income tax (benefit) expense, net

 

(6,034

)

(3,332

)

9,904

 

Extraordinary item

 

(2,189

)

 

 

(Gain) loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment, net

 

(1

)

(18

)

(69

)

Income tax benefit on exercise of stock options

 

(1,270

)

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for goodwill

 

 

 

(240

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

(31,705

)

35,797

 

48,555

 

Receivable from vendor

 

3,761

 

(1,263

)

(7,346

)

Inventory

 

(22,333

)

(67,735

)

(64,548

)

Accounts payable, accrued expenses and other current liabilities

 

22,431

 

(29,745

)

66,644

 

Income taxes payable

 

182

 

(2,979

)

3,599

 

Investment securities-trading

 

(2,211

)

(1,635

)

(125

)

Prepaid expenses and other, net

 

4,413

 

1,863

 

(7,983

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities

 

(6,628

)

(74,076

)

24,070

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

 

(13,075

)

(2,869

)

(3,159

)

Proceeds from the sale of property, plant and equipment

 

1,028

 

261

 

7,250

 

Net proceeds from sale of investment securities

 

13,227

 

 

 

Proceeds from distribution from an equity investee

 

1,286

 

4,634

 

947

 

Net proceeds from issuance of subsidiary shares

 

 

 

22,158

 

Proceeds from the sale of shares of equity investment

 

922

 

 

 

Purchase of acquired business, net of acquired cash

 

 

 

(7,106

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by investing activities

 

3,388

 

2,026

 

20,090

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Borrowings of bank obligations

 

918,785

 

901,628

 

403,043

 

Repayments on bank obligations

 

(1,013,466

)

(832,329

)

(454,300

)

Proceeds from issuance of convertible subordinated debentures

 

 

 

8,107

 

Issuance of notes payable

 

5,868

 

 

 

Payment of dividend to minority shareholder of subsidiary

 

(859

)

(1,034

)

 

Net repayments under documentary acceptances

 

(1,994

)

 

 

Principal payments on capital lease obligation

 

(19

)

(29

)

(55

)

Proceeds from exercise of stock options and warrants

 

837

 

2,317

 

132

 

Repurchase of Class A common stock

 

(1,534

)

(1,382

)

(1,125

)

Principal payments on subordinated debt

 

 

(486

)

 

Net proceeds from sale of common stock

 

96,573

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

4,198

 

68,685

 

(44,198

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

 

(54

)

(41

)

(229

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash

 

904

 

(3,406

)

(267

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash at beginning of period

 

5,527

 

6,431

 

3,025

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash at end of period

 

$

6,431

 

$

3,025

 

$

2,758

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

77



 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002

 

(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share data)

 

(1)                                  Description of Business and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

 

(a)                                  Description of Business

 

Audiovox Corporation and its subsidiaries (the Company) design and market a diverse line of products and provide related services throughout the world. These products and services include handsets and accessories for wireless communications, automotive entertainment and security products, automotive electronic accessories and consumer electronics.

 

The Company operates in two primary markets (which are also the Company’s reportable segments for accounting purposes):

 

(1)                                  Wireless communications.  The Wireless Group markets wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers.

 

(2)                                  Mobile and consumer electronics.  The Electronics Group sells autosound, mobile electronics and consumer electronics primarily to mass merchants, power retailers, specialty retailers, new car dealers, original equipment manufacturers (OEMs), independent installers of automotive accessories and the U.S. military.

 

(b)                                 Principles of Consolidation

 

The consolidated financial statements include the financial statements of Audiovox Corporation and its wholly-owned and majority-owned subsidiaries.  All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

 

(c)                                  Cash Equivalents

 

Investments with original maturities of three months or less are considered cash equivalents. There were no cash equivalents at November 30, 2001 and 2002.

 

(d)                                 Revenue Recognition

 

The Company recognizes revenue from product sales at the time of passage of title and risk of loss to the customer either at FOB Shipping Point or FOB Destination, based upon terms

 

78



 

established with the customer.  Any customer acceptance provisions are satisfied prior to revenue recognition.  There are no further obligations on the part of the Company subsequent to revenue recognition except for returns of product from the Company’s customers.  The Company does accept returns of products if properly requested, authorized and approved by the Company.  The Company records an estimate of returns of products returned by its customers.  Management continuously monitors and tracks such product returns and records the provision for the estimated amount of such future returns, based on historical experience and any notification the Company receives of pending returns. The Electronic segment’s selling price to its customers is a fixed amount that is not subject to refund or adjustment or contingent upon additional rebates.   The Wireless segment has sales agreements with certain customers that provide for a rebate of the selling price if the particular product is subsequently sold at a lower price.  The Wireless segment records an estimate of the rebate at the time of sale.

 

(e)                                  Sales Incentives

 

Both of the Company’s segments, Wireless and Electronics, offer sales incentives to its customers in the form of (1) co-operative advertising allowances; (2) market development funds and (3) volume incentive rebates.  The Electronics segment also offers other trade allowances to its customers.  The terms of the sales incentives vary by customer and are offered from time to time.  Except for other trade allowances, all sales incentives require the customer to purchase the Company’s products during a specified period of time.  All sales incentives require the customer to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period.  Although all sales incentives require customers to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period (referred to as the “claim period”), the Wireless segment historically has settled sales incentives claimed after the claim period  has expired if a customer demands payment.  The sales incentive liabilities are settled either by the customer claiming a deduction against an outstanding account receivable owed to the Company by the customer or by the customer requesting a check from the Company.  The Company is unable to demonstrate that an identifiable benefit of the sales incentives has been received as such, all costs associated with sales incentives are classified as a reduction of net sales.  The following is a summary of the various sales incentive programs offered by the Company and the related accounting policies:

 

Co-operative advertising allowances are offered to customers as reimbursement towards their costs for print or media advertising in which our product is featured on its own or in conjunction with other companies’ products (e.g., a weekly advertising circular by a mass merchant).  The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company’s sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period.  Market development funds are offered to customers in connection

 

79



 

with new product launches or entering into new markets.  Those new markets can be either new geographic areas or new customers.  The amount offered for new product launches is based upon a fixed percentage of the Company’s sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period.  The Company accrues the cost of co-operative advertising allowances and market development funds at the later of when the customer purchases our products or when the sales incentive is offered to the customer.

 

Volume incentive rebates offered to customers require that minimum quantities of product be purchased during a specified period of time.  The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company’s sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer.  Certain of the volume incentive rebates offered to customers include a sliding scale of the amount of the sales incentive with different required minimum quantities to be purchased.  The customer’s achievement of the sales threshold and, consequently, the measurement of the total rebate for the Wireless segment cannot be reasonably estimated.  Accordingly, the Wireless segment recognizes a liability for the maximum potential amount of the rebate, with the exception of certain volume incentive rebates that include very aggressive tiered levels of volume purchases as the underlying revenue transactions that result in progress by the customer toward earning the rebate or refund on a program by program basis are recognized.  The Electronics segment makes an estimate of the ultimate amount of the rebate their customers will earn based upon past history with the customer and other facts and circumstances.  The Electronics segment has the ability to estimate these volume incentive rebates as there does not exist a relatively long period of time for a particular rebate to be claimed, the Electronics segment does have historical experience with these sales incentive programs and the Electronics segment does have a large volume of relatively homogenous transactions.  Any changes in the estimated amount of volume incentive rebates are recognized immediately using a cumulative catch-up adjustment.

 

With respect to the accounting for co-operative advertising allowances, market development funds and volume incentive rebates, there was no impact upon the adoption of EITF 01-9, “Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a  Customer (Including a Reseller of Vendor’s Products)”, as the Company’s accounting policy prior to March 1, 2002 was consistent with its accounting policy after the adoption of EITF 01-9.

 

Other trade allowances are additional sales incentives that the Company provides to the Electronics segment customers subsequent to the related revenue being recognized.  In accordance with EITF 01-9, the Company records the provision for these additional sales incentives at the later of when the sales incentive is offered or when the related revenue is recognized.  Such additional sales incentives are based upon a fixed percentage of the selling

 

80



 

price to the customer, a fixed amount per unit, or a lump-sum amount.

 

For the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, reversals of previously established sales incentive liabilities amounted to $9,348, $14,369 and $4,716, respectively.  These reversals include unearned sales incentives and unclaimed sales incentives.  Unearned sales incentives are volume incentive rebates where the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during the specified time.  Volume incentive rebates for both segments are reversed into income in the period when the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during  the specified time.  Unearned sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $4,167, $9,051 and $1,354, respectively.  Unclaimed sales incentives are sales incentives earned by the customer but the customer has not claimed payment of the earned sales incentive from the Company.  Unclaimed sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $5,181, $5,318 and $3,362, respectively.

 

The accrual for earned but unclaimed sales incentives is reversed by Wireless only when management is able to conclude, based upon an individual judgement of each sales incentive, that it is remote that the customer will claim the sales incentive.  The methodology applied for determining the amount and timing of reversals for the Wireless segment is disciplined, consistent and rational.  The methodology is not systematic (formula based), as the Company makes an estimate as to when it is remote that the sales incentive will not be claimed.  Reversals by the Wireless segment of unclaimed sales incentives have historically occurred in varying periods up to 12 months after the recognition of the accrual.  In deciding on whether to reverse the sales incentive liability into income, the Company makes an assessment as to the likelihood of the customer ever claiming the funds after the claim period has expired and considers the specific facts and circumstances pertaining to the individual sales incentive.  The factors considered by management in making the decision to reverse accruals for unclaimed sales incentives include (i) past practices of the customer requesting payments after the expiration of the claim period; (ii) recent negotiations with the customer for new sales incentives; (iii) subsequent communications with the customer with regard to the status of the claim; and (iv) recent activity in the customer’s account.

 

The Electronics segment reverses earned but unclaimed sales incentives upon the expiration of the claim period.  The Company believes that the reversal of earned but unclaimed sales incentives for Electronics upon the expiration of the claim period is a disciplined, rational, consistent and systematic method of reversing unclaimed sales incentives.  For the Electronics segment, the majority of sales incentive programs are calendar-year programs.  Accordingly, the program ends on the month following the fiscal year-end and the claim period expires one year from the end of the program.

 

81



 

The accrual for sales incentives at November 30, 2001 and 2002 was $8,474 and $12,151, respectively.  The Company’s sales incentive liability may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for these arrangements.  Therefore, although the Company makes its best estimate of its sales incentive liability, many factors, including significant unanticipated changes in the purchasing volume of its customers and the lack of claims made by customers of offered and accepted sales incentives, could have significant impact on the Company’s liability for sales incentives and the Company’s reported operating results.

 

(f)                                    Inventory

 

Inventory consists principally of finished goods and is stated at the lower of  the actual cost to purchase (primarily on a weighted moving average basis) and/or the current estimated market value of the inventory less expected costs to sell the inventory.  The Company regularly reviews inventory quantities on-hand and records a provision for excess and obsolete inventory based primarily on open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations.  As demonstrated in recent years, demand for the Company’s products can fluctuate significantly.  A significant sudden increase in the demand for the Company’s products could result in a short-term increase in the cost of inventory purchases while a significant decrease in demand could result in an increase in the amount of excess inventory quantities on-hand.  In addition, the Company’s industry is characterized by rapid technological change and  frequent new product introductions that could result in an increase in the amount of obsolete inventory quantities on-hand.  In such situations, the Company generally does not obtain price protection from its vendors, however, on occasion, the Company has received price protection which reduces the cost of inventory.  Since price protection reduces the cost of inventory, as the Company sells the inventory for which it has received price protection, the amount is reflected as a reduction to cost of sales.  There can be no assurances that the Company will be successful in negotiating such price protection from its vendors in the future.

 

The Company has, on occasion, performed upgrades on certain inventory on behalf of its vendors.   The reimbursements the Company receives to perform these upgrades are reflected as a reduction to the cost of inventory and is recognized as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory is sold. Additionally, the Company’s estimates of excess and obsolete inventory may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for excess and obsolete inventory.  In the future, if the Company’s inventory is determined to be overvalued, it would be required to recognize such costs in its cost of goods sold at the time of such determination.  Likewise, if the Company

 

82



 

does not properly estimate the lower of cost or market of its  inventory and it is therefore determined to be undervalued, it may have over-reported its cost of goods sold in previous periods and would be required to recognize such additional operating income at the time of sale.  Therefore, although the Company makes every effort to ensure the accuracy of its forecasts of future product demand, any significant unanticipated changes in demand or technological developments could have a significant impact on the value of the Company’s inventory and its reported operating results.

 

The Company maintains a significant investment in inventory and, therefore, is subject to the risk of losses on write-downs to market and inventory obsolescence.  During the fourth quarter of  2000, the Company decided to substantially exit the analog phone line of business to reflect the shift in the wireless industry from analog to digital technology and recorded a charge of approximately $8,152 to reduce its carrying value of its analog inventory to estimated market value.  During the second quarter  of 2001, the Company recorded an additional charge of approximately $13,500 to further adjust the carrying value of its analog inventory to market.

 

During the fourth quarter of 2001, Wireless recorded inventory write-downs to market of  $7,150 as a result of the reduction of selling prices primarily related to digital hand-held phones during the first quarter of 2002 in anticipation of new digital technologies.  During the year ended November 30, 2002, Wireless recorded inventory write-downs to market of $13,823.  These write-downs were made based upon open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the respective balance sheet dates as well as indications from our customers based upon current negotiations.   It is reasonably possible that additional write-downs to market may be required in the future given the continued emergence of new technologies, however, no estimate can be made of such write-downs.  At November 30, 2002, Wireless had on hand 640,084 units of previously written-down inventory, which approximated $94,264.

 

For certain inventory items, the Company is entitled to receive price protection in the event the selling price to its customers is less than the purchase price from the manufacturer.  The Company records such price protection, as necessary, at the time of the sale of the units.  As of November 30, 2002, such price protection amounted to $32,643, of which $27,683 was recorded as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory was sold.  The other $4,960 in price protection for 2002 has been reflected as a reduction to the remaining inventory cost.

 

83



 

(g)                                 Investment Securities

 

The Company classifies its equity securities in one of two categories:  trading or available-for-sale.  Trading securities are bought and held principally for the purpose of selling them in the near term. All other securities not included in trading are classified as available-for-sale.

 

Trading and available-for-sale securities are recorded at fair value.  Unrealized holding gains and losses on trading securities are included in earnings.  Unrealized holding gains and losses, net of the related tax effect, on available-for-sale securities are excluded from earnings and are reported as a component of  accumulated other comprehensive income until realized.  Realized gains and losses from the sale of available-for-sale securities are determined on a specific identification basis.

 

A decline in the market value of any available-for-sale security below cost that is deemed other-than-temporary results in a reduction in carrying amount to fair value.  The impairment is charged to earnings and a new cost basis for the security is established (such a charge was recorded during fiscal 2002 - Note 9).  Dividend and interest income are recognized when earned.  The Company considers numerous factors, on a case by case basis, in evaluating whether the decline in market value of an available-for-sale security below cost is other-than-temporary.  Such factors include, but are not limited to, (i)the length of time and the extent to which the market value has been less than cost; (ii) the financial condition and the near-term prospects of the issuer of the investment; and (iii) whether the Company’s intent to retain the investment for the period of time is sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in market value.

 

(h)                                 Derivative Financial Instruments

 

Effective December 1, 2000, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” (Statement 133), which establishes new accounting and reporting guidelines for derivative instruments and hedging activities. Statement 133 requires the recognition of all derivative financial instruments as either assets or liabilities in the statements of financial condition and measurement of those instruments at fair value.  Changes in the fair values of those derivatives are reported in earnings or other comprehensive income (loss) depending on the designation of the derivative and whether it qualifies for hedge accounting. The accounting for gains and losses associated with changes in the fair value of a derivative and the effect on the consolidated financial statements will depend on its hedge designation and whether the hedge is highly effective in achieving offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of the asset or liability hedged.  Under the provisions of Statement 133, the method that will be used for assessing the effectiveness of a hedging derivative, as well as the measurement approach for determining the ineffective aspects of the hedge, must be established at the

 

84



 

inception of the hedged instrument.  The adoption of Statement 133 had no impact on the Company’s results of operations or financial position.

 

The Company’s evaluations of hedge effectiveness are subject to assumptions based on the terms and timing of the underlying exposures. For a fair value hedge, both the effective and ineffective portions of the change in fair value of the derivative instrument, along with an adjustment to the carrying amount of the hedge item for fair value changes attributable to the hedge risk, are recognized in earnings.  For a cash flow hedge, changes in the fair value of a derivative instrument that is highly effective are deferred in accumulated other comprehensive income or loss until the underlying hedged item is recognized in earnings.  The ineffective portion is recognized in earnings immediately.  If a fair value or cash flow hedge was to cease to qualify for hedge accounting or be terminated, it would continue to be carried on the balance sheet at fair value until settled, but hedge accounting would be discontinued prospectively.  If a forecasted transaction were no longer probable of occurring, amounts previously deferred in accumulated other comprehensive income would be recognized immediately in earnings.

 

The Company, as a policy, does not use derivative financial instruments for trading purposes.  The Company conducts business in several foreign currencies and, as a result, is subject to foreign currency exchange rate risk due to the effects that exchange rate movements of these currencies have on the Company’s costs.  To minimize the effect of exchange rate fluctuations on costs, the Company enters into forward exchange rate contracts.   The Company, as a policy, does not enter into forward exchange contracts for trading purposes. The forward exchange rate contracts are entered into as hedges of inventory purchase commitments and of trade receivables due in foreign currencies.

 

Gains and losses on the forward exchange contracts that qualify as hedges are reported as a component of the underlying transaction.  Foreign currency transactions which have not been hedged are marked to market on a current basis with gains and losses recognized through income and reflected in other income (expense).  In addition, any previously deferred gains and losses on hedges which are terminated prior to the transaction date are recognized in current income when the hedge is terminated.

 

At November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company had no contracts to exchange foreign currencies in the form of forward exchange contracts.  For the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, gains and losses on foreign currency transactions which were not hedged were not material.  For the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, there were no gains or losses as a result of terminating hedges prior to the transaction date.

 

85



 

(i)                                     Debt Issuance Costs

 

Costs incurred in connection with the restructuring of bank obligations (Note 15) have been capitalized.  During 2000, the Company capitalized an additional $148 in fees associated with the restructuring and various amendments to the Company’s credit agreement.  These charges are amortized over the lives of the respective agreements.  Amortization expense of these costs amounted to $434, $336 and $379 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

(j)                                     Property, Plant and Equipment

 

Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost.  Equipment under capital lease is stated at the present value of minimum lease payments.  Depreciation is calculated on the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets as follows:

 

Buildings

 

20-30 years

 

Furniture, fixtures and displays

 

5-10 years

 

Machinery and equipment

 

5-10 years

 

Computer hardware and software

 

3-5 years

 

Automobiles

 

3 years

 

 

Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the lease term or estimated useful life of the asset.  Assets acquired under capital lease are amortized over the term of the lease.

 

Capitalized computer software costs obtained for internal use are amortized on a straight-line basis.

 

(a)                                  Intangible Assets

 

Intangible assets consist of patents, trademarks and the excess cost over fair value of equity investments (goodwill).

 

In July 2001, the Financial Accounting Standards Board  (FASB) issued SFAS No. 141, “Business Combinations” and SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”.  SFAS No. 141 requires that the purchase method of accounting be used for all future business combinations and specifies criteria intangible assets acquired in a business combination must meet to be recognized and reported apart from goodwill.  SFAS No. 142 requires that goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives no longer be amortized, but instead be tested for impairment at least annually in accordance with the provisions of SFAS No. 142.  SFAS

 

86



 

No. 142 also requires that intangible assets with estimable useful lives be amortized over their respective estimated useful lives and reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 121, “Accounting for the impairment of Long-Live Assets to be Disposed Of”.

 

The Company early adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and SFAS No. 142 as of December 1, 2001.  As a result of adopting the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and 142, the Company did not record amortization expense relating to its goodwill, which approximated $9,616, during the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002.  The Company was not required under SFAS No. 142 to assess the useful life and residual value of its goodwill as the Company’s goodwill, at the time of adoption,  was equity method goodwill and, as such, will continue to be evaluated for impairment under Accounting Pronouncement Board No. 18, “The Equity Method of Accounting for Investments in Common Stock”, as amended.

 

As required by the adoption of SFAS No. 142, the Company reassessed the useful lives and residual values of all acquired intangible assets to make any necessary amortization period adjustments.  Based upon that assessment, no adjustments were made to the amortization period of residual values of other intangible assets.  The cost of other intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their respective lives.  Accumulated amortization on the Company’s intangible assets of $8,244 and $10,337 approximated $3,502 and $3,511 as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

As of November 30, 2001 and November 30, 2002, the Company had intangible assets subject to amortization of $711 and $711, respectively, and related accumulated amortization of $692 and $711, respectively, which pertained to trademarks and patents. Amortization expense for intangible assets subject to amortization amounted to $15 and $9 for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  As of November 30, 2002, all intangible assets subject to amortization have been fully amortized.  Accordingly, the estimated aggregate amortization expense for each of the five succeeding years ending November 30, 2007 amounts to $0.  Had SFAS No. 142 been applied retrospectively to the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, there would be no impact to reported net income or loss per share, respectively.

 

As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company had unamortized goodwill in the amount of $4,732 and $6,826, respectively.  In accordance with SFAS No. 142, the Company wrote-off its unamortized negative goodwill  of $240 as of the date of adoption, which has been reflected in the consolidated statements of operations as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle.  During the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, the Company recorded $16 and $16, respectively, for the amortization of negative goodwill.  In  March 2002, in connection with the purchase of certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc.

 

87



 

by Code Systems, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Audiovox Electronics Corp., the Company recorded $1,854 of goodwill.

 

88



 

The following table presents adjusted net losses and loss per share data restated to include the retroactive impact of the adoption of SFAS No. 142:

 

 

 

Years Ended November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

Reported net income (loss) before extraordinary item and accounting change

 

$

25,303

 

$

(7,198

)

$

(14,280

)

Extraordinary item - gain on extinguishment of debt

 

2,189

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax

 

 

 

240

 

Reported net income (loss)

 

27,492

 

(7,198

)

(14,040

)

Add back:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill amortization, net of tax

 

343

 

224

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss)

 

$

27,835

 

$

(6,974

)

$

(14,040

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic net income (loss) per common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reported net income (loss) before extraordinary item and accounting change

 

$

1.19

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.65

)

Extraordinary item - gain on extinguishment of debt

 

0.10

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax

 

 

 

0.01

 

Net income (loss)

 

1.29

 

(0.33

)

(0.64

)

Goodwill amortization, net of tax

 

0.01

 

0.01

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss)

 

$

1.30

 

$

(0.32

)

$

(0.64

)

Diluted net income (loss) per common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reported net income (loss) before extraordinary item and accounting change

 

$

1.12

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.65

)

Extraordinary item - gain on extinguishment of debt

 

0.10

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax

 

 

 

0.01

 

Net income (loss)

 

1.22

 

(0.33

)

(0.64

)

Goodwill amortization, net of tax

 

0.01

 

0.01

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss)

 

$

1.23

 

$

(0.32

)

$

(0.64

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

21,393,566

 

21,877,100

 

21,850,035

 

Diluted

 

22,565,806

 

21,877,100

 

21,850,035

 

 

89



 

The change in carrying amount of goodwill is as follows:

 

 

 

Year Ended
November 30,
2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net balance as of November 30, 2001

 

$

4,732

 

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

240

 

Goodwill acquired during the period

 

1,854

 

Net Balance as of November 30, 2002

 

$

6,826

 

 

(a)                                  Equity Investments

 

The Company has common stock investments which are accounted for by the equity method as the Company owns between 20% and 50% of the common stock.

 

The Company applies the equity method of accounting to its investments in entities where the Company has non-controlling ownership interests.  The Company’s share of its equity method investees earnings or losses is included in the consolidated statements of operations. The Company eliminates its pro rata share of gross profit on sales to its equity method investees for inventory on hand at the investees at the end of the year.  A description of the Company’s equity investments and the related transactions between the Company and these investees is discussed in Note 11.

 

(b)                                 Cellular Telephone Commissions

 

Under various agency agreements, the Company receives an initial activation commission for obtaining subscribers for cellular telephone services. The agreements may contain provisions for additional commissions based upon usage and length of continued subscription.  The agreements also provide for the reduction or elimination of initial activation commissions if subscribers deactivate service within stipulated periods.  The Company has provided a liability for estimated cellular deactivations which is reflected in the accompanying consolidated financial statements as a reduction of accounts receivable.

 

The Company recognizes sales revenue for the initial activation and residual commissions based upon usage on the accrual basis.  Such commissions approximated $32,475, $29,859 and $26,756 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  Related commissions paid to outside selling representatives for cellular activations are included in cost

 

90



 

of sales in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations and amounted to $23,186, $22,390 and $18,673 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

(n)                                 Advertising

 

The Company expenses the costs of advertising as incurred, excluding co-operative advertising (see sales incentives Note 1(e).  During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had no direct response advertising.

 

(o)                                 Product Warranties and Product Repair Costs

 

The Company generally warrants its products against certain manufacturing and other defects.  The Company provides warranties for all of its products ranging from 90 days to the lifetime of the product.  Warranty expenses are accrued at the time of sale based on the Company’s estimated cost to repair expected returns for products.  This liability is based primarily on historical experiences of actual warranty claims as well as current information on repair costs.  The warranty liability of $9,165 and $9,143 is recorded in accrued expenses in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  In addition, the Company records a reserve for product repair costs.  This reserve is based upon the quantities of defective inventory on hand and an estimate of the cost to repair such defective inventory.  The reserve for product repair costs of $3,902 and $6,267 is recorded as a reduction to inventory in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  Warranty claims and product repair costs expense for each of the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were $8,256, $11,319 and $6,985, respectively. 

 

The following table provides the changes in the Company’s product warranties and product repair costs for 2002:

 

December 1, 2001

 

$

13,066

 

Liabilities accrued for warranties issued during the period

 

6,985

 

Warranty claims paid during the period

 

(4,641

)

November 30, 2002

 

$

15,410

 

 

(p)                                 Foreign Currency

 

With the exception of a subsidiary operation in Venezuela, which was deemed a hyper inflationary economy in fiscal 2000 and 2001, assets and liabilities of those subsidiaries and equity investees located outside the United States whose cash flows are primarily in local currencies have been translated at rates of exchange at the end of the period or historical exchange rates, as appropriate.  Revenues and expenses have been translated at the weighted average rates of exchange in

 

91



 

effect during the period.  Gains and losses resulting from translation are accumulated in the cumulative foreign currency translation account in accumulated other comprehensive income.  For the operation in Venezuela, financial statements are translated at either current or historical exchange rates, as appropriate.  These adjustments, along with gains and losses on currency transactions, are reflected in the consolidated statements of operations for fiscal 2000 and 2001.  During the first quarter of fiscal 2002 (January 1, 2002), Venezuela ceased to be deemed a hyper-inflationary economy (see Note 2).

 

Exchange gains and losses on intercompany balances of a long-term nature are also recorded in the cumulative foreign currency translation adjustment account in accumulated other comprehensive loss.  Exchange gains and losses on available-for-sale investment securities are recorded in the unrealized gain (loss) on marketable securities in accumulated other comprehensive loss.  Other foreign currency transaction gains of $193,  $200 and $418 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively, were included in other income.

 

(q)                                 Income Taxes

 

Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method.  Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit carryforwards.  Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled (Note 16).  The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date.

 

(r)                                    Net Income (Loss) Per Common Share

 

Basic earnings (loss) per common share is based upon the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period.  Diluted earnings (loss) per common share reflects the potential dilution that would occur if securities or other contracts to issue common stock were exercised or converted into common stock.  Dilutive net loss per common share for fiscal 2001 and 2002 is the same as basic net loss per common share due to the anti-dilutive effect of the exercise of stock options.

 

(s)                                  Supplementary Financial Statement Information

 

Interest income of approximately $1,616, $670 and $509 for the years ended November

 

92



 

30, 2000, 2001 and 2002  respectively, is included in other, net, in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations.

 

(t)                                    Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, including the allowance for doubtful accounts, allowance for cellular deactivations,  inventory valuation, recoverability of deferred tax assets, valuation of long-lived assets and accrued sales incentives, warranty reserves and disclosure of the contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 

(u)                                 Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed of

 

The Company accounts for its long-lived assets in accordance with the provisions of SFAS No.121.  Statement 121 requires that long-lived assets and certain identifiable intangibles be reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable.  Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by comparison of the carrying amount of an asset to the future net cash flows expected to be generated by the asset.  If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of the assets exceed the fair value of assets. Assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell.   

 

In October 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets” (Statement 144), which addresses financial accounting and reporting for the impairment or disposal of long-lived assets.  This statement supersedes Statement 121 while retaining the fundamental recognition and measurement provisions of that statement.  Statement 144 requires that a long-lived asset to be abandoned, exchanged for a similar productive asset or distributed to owners in a spin-off to be considered held and used until it is disposed of.  However, Statement 144 requires that management consider revising the depreciable life of such long-lived asset.  With respect to long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale, Statement 144 retains the provisions of Statement 121 and, therefore, requires that discontinued operations no longer be measured on a net realizable value basis and that future operating losses associated with such discontinued operations no longer be recognized before they occur.  Statement 144 is effective for all fiscal quarters of fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2001, and will

 

93



 

thus be adopted by the Company on December 1, 2002 (fiscal 2003).  The adoption of Statement 144 did not have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

(v)                                 Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation

 

As allowed by SFAS No.  123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation”, the Company applies the intrinsic value-based method of accounting prescribed by Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees”, and related interpretations, in accounting for its stock-based compensation plans (APB No. 25).

 

(w)                               Reporting Comprehensive Income

 

Effective December 1, 1998, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 130, “Reporting Comprehensive Income” (Statement 130).  Statement 130 requires that all items recognized under accounting standards as components of comprehensive income be reported in an annual financial statement that is displayed with the same prominence as other annual financial statements.  Other comprehensive income may include foreign currency translation adjustments, minimum pension liability adjustments and unrealized gains and losses on investment securities classified as available-for-sale and fair market value changes for cash flow hedges.

 

(x)                                   New Accounting Pronouncements

 

In July 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 143, “Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations” (Statement  143).  Statement 143 is effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 2002, and this will be adopted by the Company on December 1, 2003 (fiscal 2004) and establishes an accounting standard requiring the recording of the fair value of liabilities associated with the retirement of long-lived assets in the period in which they are incurred.  The Company does not expect the adoption of Statement 143 to have a significant effect on its results of operations or its financial position.

 

SFAS 145 “Rescission of SFAS Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of SFAS No. 13 and Technical Corrections”.  This Statement updates, clarifies and simplifies existing accounting pronouncements by rescinding Statement 4, which required all gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated and, if material, classified as an extraordinary item, net of related income tax effect.  As a result, the criteria in Opinion 30 will now be used to classify those gains and losses. This statement will have no material effect on the Company’s financial statements.

 

94



 

In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 148, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation - Transition and Disclosure”.  SFAS No. 148 provides alternative methods of transition for a voluntary change to the fair value method of accounting for stock-based employee compensation as originally provided by SFAS No. 123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation”.  Additionally, SFAS No. 148 amends the disclosure requirements of SFAS No. 123 to require prominent disclosure in both annual and interim financial statements about the method of accounting for stock-based compensation and the effect of the method used on reported results.  The transitional requirements of SFAS No. 148 will be effective for all financial statements for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2002.  The disclosure requirements shall be effective for financial reports containing condensed financial statements for interim periods beginning after December 31, 2002.  The Company expects to adopt the disclosure portion of this statement for the fiscal quarter ending February 28, 2003.  The application of this standard will have no impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

In February 2003, the EITF Issued 02-16, “Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for Certain Consideration Received from a Vendor”. This EITF provides guidance on the income statement classification of amounts received by a customer, including a reseller and guidance regarding timing of recognition for volume rebates.  The Company does not believe that adoption of this new standard, which will be applied prospectively by the Company for new arrangements, including modifications of existing arrangements, entered into after December 31, 2002, will have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

In November 2002, the FASB issued Interpretation No.  45 (FIN 45), “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantors, Including Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others”.  FIN 45 elaborates on the disclosures to be made by a guarantor in its interim and annual financial statements about its obligations under certain guarantees that it has issued.  It also clarifies that a guarantor is required to recognize, at the inception of a guarantee, a liability for the fair value of the obligation undertaken in issuing the guarantee.  The initial recognition and initial measurement provisions of FIN 45 are applicable on a prospective basis to guarantees issued or modified after December 31, 2002, irrespective of the guarantor’s fiscal year-end.  The disclosure requirements of FIN 45 are effective for financial statements of interim or annual periods ending after December 15, 2002.  The Company does not expect the adoption of FIN 45 to have a material effect on its consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

In January 2003, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, an interpretation of ARB No. 51”.  FIN 46 addresses the consolidation by business enterprises of variable interest entities as defined in the Interpretation.  FIN 46 is effective for all new variable interest entities created or acquired after January 31, 2003.  For

 

95



 

variable interest entities created or acquired prior to February 1, 2003, the provisions of FIN 46 must be applied for the first interim period beginning after June 15, 2003.   The adoption of FIN 46 is being evaluated to determine what impact, if any, the adoption of the provisions will have on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

 

(y)                                 Shipping and Handling Costs

 

In fiscal 2001, the Company adopted the provisions of EITF Issue No. 00-10, “Accounting for Shipping and Handling Fees and Costs”, which requires the Company to report all amounts billed to a customer related to shipping and handling as revenue. The Company includes all costs incurred for shipping and handling as cost of sales. The Company has reclassified such billed amounts, which were previously netted in cost of sales to net sales. As a result of this reclassification, net sales and cost of goods sold were increased by $2,162 and $1,548 for years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, respectively.

 

96



 

(z)                                   Issuances of Subsidiary Stock

 

The Company’s accounting policy on the issuances of subsidiary stock is to recognize through earnings the gain on the sale of the shares as long as the sale of the shares is not part of a broader corporate reorganization planned or contemplated by the Company and realization of the gain is assured.

 

(aa)                            Reclassifications

 

Certain reclassifications have been made to the 2000 and 2001 consolidated financial statements in order to conform to the 2002 presentation.

 

(2)                                  Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The Company has restated its consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and for the quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002.  In addition, the Company has reclassified certain expenses from operating expenses to cost of sales for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for each of the quarters in the nine months ended August 31, 2002.  These restatement adjustments are the result of the misapplication of generally accepted accounting principles.

 

The net effect of all of the restatement adjustments is as follows:

 

 

 

Fiscal
2000

 

Fiscal
2001

 

First
Quarter
2002

 

Second
Quarter
2002

 

Third
Quarter
2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(Unaudited)

 

(Unaudited)

 

(Unaudited)

 

Increase (decrease) income/(increase) decrease (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

$

263

 

$

1,011

 

$

(1,308

)

$

(782

)

$

751

 

Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss)

 

263

 

1,011

 

(1,308

)

(782

)

751

 

Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss) per common share - diluted

 

$

0.01

 

$

0.05

 

$

(0.06

)

$

(0.03

)

$

0.04

 

 

97



 

The following table provides additional information regarding these restatement adjustments:

 

Effects of Restatement Adjustments on Net Income or Net Loss

(in thousands)

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease)
in Net Income for the
Fiscal Year Ended
November 30, 2000

 

(Increase) Decrease in
Net Loss for the Fiscal
Year Ended November
30, 2001

 

Increase (Decrease) in
Net Income for the
Nine Months Ended
August 31, 2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unaudited

 

Restatement adjustments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue recognition

 

$

(779

)

$

779

 

 

Timing of revenue

 

 

 

(15

)

$

(103

)

Litigation

 

 

 

(373

)

427

 

Foreign currency translation

 

 

 

(1,491

)

Inventory pricing

 

 

 

420

 

Sales incentives

 

1,884

 

910

 

847

 

Gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares

 

 

 

(1,556

)

Operating expense reclassification to cost of sales (2)

 

 

 

 

Total adjustment to pre-tax income (loss)

 

1,105

 

1,301

 

(1,456

)

(Provision for) recovery of income taxes

 

(842

)

(310

)

204

 

Minority interest  (1)

 

 

20

 

(87

)

Total effect on net income (loss)

 

$

263

 

$

1,011

 

$

(1,339

)

 


(1)                                  This adjustment reflects the impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.     

 

(2)                                  This adjustment represents a reclassification of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs (which are components of operating expenses) to cost of sales.  This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or (loss) for any fiscal year or period presented herein.

 

See Note 26 “Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data - As Restated”  for restatement adjustments to previously reported unaudited quarterly consolidated statements of operations data for the quarters ended February 28, 2001 through August 31, 2002 as a result of the restatements and reclassifications.

 

The following discussion addresses each of the restatement adjustments and the reclassification adjustment  for the corrections of accounting errors.  Any references to quarterly amounts are unaudited.

 

(a)                                  Revenue recognition. The Company overstated net sales in each of the third and fourth quarters of  fiscal 2000 for shipments of product that did not conform to the technical requirements of the customer (i.e., the goods were non-conforming).  The Company did not properly evaluate this shipment of non-conforming goods as required in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin

 

98



 

No.  101 (SAB No.  101), “Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements”, which would preclude revenue recognition until the specific performance obligations have been met by the Company.   These product shipments resulted in the Company overstating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2000.  During the first quarter of fiscal 2001, the Company recorded a sales return of this fiscal 2000 non-conforming product sale. The recording of this product return (sales reversal) resulted in the Company understating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2001.

 

(b)                                 Timing of revenue.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and  the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company (overstated) understated  net sales by $(976), $857, $(4,601), $(7,757) and $10,472, respectively, as the timing of revenue recognition was not in accordance with the established shipping terms with certain customers.  SAB 101 specifically states that delivery generally is not considered to have occurred unless the customer has taken title (which is in this situation when the product was delivered to the customer’s site).  Accordingly, the Company should have deferred revenue recognition until delivery was made to the customer’s site.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, gross profit was overstated (understated) by $34, ($19), $99, $562 and ($535), respectively.  During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, operating expenses were overstated (understated) by $0, $0, $17, $136 and ($130), respectively.

 

(c)                                  Litigation.  During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2001 and each of the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overestimated its  provisions for certain litigation matters, thereby overstating cost of sales by $314, $176, $345 and $457 for each respective quarterly period.  Also, the Company understated operating expenses by $497 in the first quarter of fiscal 2002 as a result of not recording a settlement offer in the period the Company offered it.

 

During the second, third and fourth quarters of 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of 2002, the Company understated (overstated) operating expenses by $189, $302, $196, $78 and $276 and ($300), respectively as a result of inappropriately deferring costs related to an insurance claim.  The Company’s insurance company refused to defend the Company against a legal claim made against the Company.  The Company took legal action against the insurance company and was unsuccessful.  The Company was improperly capitalizing costs that were not probable of recovery.

 

(d)                                 Foreign currency translation.  During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company did not properly account for a change in accounting for its Venezuelan subsidiary as operating in a non-highly inflationary economy. In fiscal 2001 and in prior years, Venezuela was deemed to be a highly-inflationary economy in accordance with certain technical accounting

 

99



 

pronouncements. Effective January 1, 2002, it was deemed that Venezuela  should cease to be considered a highly-inflationary economy, however, the Company did not account for this change.  The Company incorrectly recorded the foreign currency translation adjustment in other income rather than as other comprehensive income.  As a result, the Company  understated other expenses, net, by $1,360 for the first quarter of fiscal 2002, overstated other income, net, by $71 for the second quarter of fiscal 2002 and understated other expenses, net, by $243 for the third quarter of fiscal 2002.   Also  the Company overstated operating expenses by $41, $54 and $88 for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively.

 

(e)                                  Inventory pricing.  During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales related to an inventory pricing error that occurred at its Venezuelan subsidiary.  The Company was not aware of this pricing error until the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002 and, accordingly, was not properly pricing its inventory at the lower of cost or market in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  As a result, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales by $387, ($2) and $35, for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively.

 

(f)                                    Sales incentives.  During fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment overestimated accruals for additional sales incentives (other trade allowances)  that were not yet offered to its customers.  As a result, for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $1,884, $784 and $292, respectively.

 

Furthermore, during fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002,the Electronics segment was also not reversing earned and unclaimed sales incentives (i.e., cooperative advertising, market development and volume incentive rebate funds) upon the expiration of the established claim period.  As a result, for fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $126 and $555, respectively.

 

(g)                                 Gain on the Issuance of Subsidiary Shares.  During the second quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company  overstated the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares by $1,735 due to expenses related to this issuance being charged to additional paid in capital.   This adjustment also reflects the impact of the other restatement adjustments on the calculation of the gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares of $179 that was originally recorded by the Company in the quarter ended May 31, 2002.  As a result, the Company decreased the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares and increased the additional paid in capital by $1,556. 

 

(h)                                 Income taxes.  Income taxes were adjusted for the restatement adjustments discussed above for each period presented.

 

100



 

The Company also applied income taxes to minority interest amounts during all quarters of fiscal 2000 and 2001, as well as the first three quarters of fiscal 2002.  As a  result of all these adjustments, the Company overstated (understated) the provision for/recovery of  income taxes by $(842), ($310) and $(455) for fiscal 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively.

 

(i)                                     Operating expense reclassification.  The Company reclassified certain costs as operating expenses, which were included  as a component of  warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs, which should have been classified as a component of cost of sales.  The effect of this reclassification on fiscal 2000 and 2001 was to increase cost of sales and decrease operating expenses by $17,962 and $20,024, respectively.  The effect of this reclassification for the nine months ended August 31, 2002 was to understate cost of sales and overstate operating expenses by $15,488.  This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or loss for any fiscal year or period presented herein.  This reclassification reduced gross margin by 1.0, 1.6 and 1.9 percentage points for fiscal years November 30, 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively.

 

The following represents the effect of the restatement and reclassification adjustments in the fiscal 2000 and 2001 consolidated statements of operations and consolidated balance sheet:

 

Consolidated Statements of Operations

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

class=Section2>

 

 

November 30, 2000

 

 

 

As Reported(1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

1,687,573

 

$

(17,282

)(2)(5)

 

$

1,670,291

 

Cost of sales

 

1,552,091

 

(18,387

)(2)

$

17,962

 

1,551,666

(3)

Gross profit

 

135,482

 

1,105

 

(17,962

)

118,625

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

29,056

 

 

 

29,056

 

General and administrative

 

49,800

 

 

(3,334

)(3)

46,466

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

18,102

 

 

(14,628

)(3)

3,474

 

Total operating expenses

 

96,958

 

 

(17,962

)

78,996

 

Operating income (loss)

 

38,524

 

1,105

 

 

39,629

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

2,514

 

 

 

2,514

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes minority interest and extraordinary item

 

41,038

 

1,105

 

 

42,143

 

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

14,924

 

842

(4)

 

15,766

 

Minority interest

 

(1,074

)

 

 

(1,074

)

Income (loss) before extraordinary item

 

25,040

 

263

 

 

25,303

 

 

101



 

 

 

November 30, 2000

 

 

 

As Reported(1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt

 

2,189

 

 

 

2,189

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

27,229

 

$

263

 

 

$

27,492

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic) before extraordinary item

 

$

1.17

 

$

0.02

 

 

$

1.19

 

Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt

 

0.10

 

 

 

0.10

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic)

 

$

1.27

 

$

0.02

 

 

$

1.29

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) before extraordinary item

 

$

1.11

 

$

0.01

 

 

$

1.12

 

Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt

 

0.10

 

 

 

0.10

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted)

 

$

1.21

 

$

0.01

 

 

$

1.22

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,393,566

 

 

 

 

 

21,393,566

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

22,565,806

 

 

 

 

 

22,565,806

 

 


(1)                                  Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively.

(2)                                  Amounts reflect adjustments for (a) revenue recognition.

(3)                                  Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(4)                                  Amounts restated to reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(5)                                  Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

 

102



 

Consolidated Statements of Operations

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

 

 

November 30, 2001

 

 

 

As Reported(1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

Net sales

 

$

1,256,634

 

$

19,957

(2)(6)

 

$

1,276,591

 

Cost of sales

 

1,167,208

 

17,969

(2)(4)

$

20,024

(3)

1,205,201

 

Gross profit

 

89,426

 

1,988

 

(20,024

)

71,390

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

30,039

 

 

 

30,039

 

General and administrative

 

46,405

 

687

(4)

(587

)(3)

46,505

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

23,519

 

 

(19,437

)(3)

4,082

 

Total operating expenses

 

99,963

 

687

 

(20,024

)

80,626

 

Operating income (loss)

 

(10,537

)

1,301

 

 

(9,236

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

(2,246

)

 

 

 

(2,246

)

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest

 

(12,783

)

1,301

 

 

(11,482

)

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

(3,937

)

310

(5)

 

(3,627

)

Minority interest

 

637

 

20

(7)

 

657

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

(8,209

)

$

1,011

 

 

$

(7,198

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic)

 

$

(0.38

)

$

0.05

 

 

$

(0.33

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted)

 

$

(0.38

)

$

0.05

 

 

$

(0.33

)

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,877,100

 

 

 

 

 

21,877,100

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

21,877,100

 

 

 

 

 

21,877,100

 

 


(1)                                  Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively.

(2)                                  Amounts reflect adjustments for (a) revenue recognition and (b) timing of revenue .

(3)                                  Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(4)                                  Amount reflect adjustments for (c) litigation.

(5)                                  Amount restated to reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(6)                                  Amount reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

(7)                                  Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.

 

103



 

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(In thousands, except share data)

 

 

 

November 30, 2001

 

 

 

As Reported

 

Restatement Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash

 

$

3,025

 

 

$

3,025

 

Accounts receivable, net

 

238,476

**

$

(119

)

238,357

 

Inventory, net

 

225,662

 

97

 

225,759

 

Receivable from vendor

 

6,919

 

(91

)

6,828

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

7,632

 

7

 

7,639

 

Deferred income taxes, net

 

11,997

 

(32

)

11,965

 

Total current assets

 

493,711

 

(138

)

493,573

 

Investment securities

 

5,777

 

 

5,777

 

Equity investments

 

10,268

 

 

10,268

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

25,687

 

 

25,687

 

Excess cost over fair value of assets acquired and other intangible assets, net

 

4,742

 

 

4,742

 

Deferred income taxes, net

 

3,148

 

 

3,148

 

Other assets

 

1,302

 

 

1,302

 

Total assets

 

$

544,635

 

$

(138

)

$

544,497

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

$

57,162

 

 

$

57,162

 

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

 

41,854

 

$

283

 

42,137

 

Accrued sales incentives

 

11,267

 

(2,793

)

8,474

 

Income taxes payable

 

3,035

 

1,119

 

4,154

 

Bank obligations

 

92,213

 

 

92,213

 

Notes payable

 

5,267

 

 

5,267

 

Total current liabilities

 

210,798

 

(1,391

)

209,407

 

Long-term debt

 

 

 

 

Capital lease obligation

 

6,196

 

 

6,196

 

Deferred income taxes payable

 

 

 

 

Deferred compensation

 

3,844

 

 

3,844

 

Total liabilities

 

220,838

 

(1,391

)

219,447

 

Minority interest

 

1,851

 

(21

)

1,830

 

Stockholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock, liquidation preference of $2,500

 

2,500

 

 

2,500

 

Common stock:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class A

 

207

 

 

207

 

Class B

 

22

 

 

22

 

Paid-in capital

 

250,785

 

 

250,785

 

Retained earnings

 

82,162

 

1,274

 

83,436

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

(6,344

)

 

(6,344

)

Treasury stock, at cost, 909,537 and 1,072,737 Class A common stock 2001 and 2002, respectively

 

(7,386

)

 

(7,386

)

Total stockholders’ equity

 

321,946

 

1,274

 

323,220

 

Commitments and contingencies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

 

$

544,635

 

$

(138

)

$

544,497

 

 


**The Company reclassified $11,267 of sales incentives from accounts receivable to accrued sales incentives.

 

104



 

As a result of the restatement for fiscal 2000 and 2001, there has not been any changes to the Company’s cash flows from operations, investing activities, or financing activities from previously reported amounts.

 

(3)                                  Issuance of Subsidiary Shares

 

On May 29, 2002, Toshiba Corporation (Toshiba) purchased an additional 20% of ACC, approximately 31 shares at approximately $774  per share, for approximately $23,900 in cash, bringing Toshiba’s total ownership interest in Audiovox Communications Corp.  (ACC) to 25%.  In addition, Toshiba paid $8,100 in exchange for an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note).  The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1¾% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003.  The unpaid principal amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest, on May 31, 2007 and automatically renews for an additional five years.  In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a 25% interest in ACC, but under no circumstances can Toshiba convert the Note to exceed a 25% interest in ACC. 

 

In connection with the transaction, the Company, ACC and Toshiba entered into a stockholders agreement. The stockholders agreement provides for the composition of the board of directors of ACC and identifies certain items, other than in the ordinary course of business, that ACC cannot do without prior approval from Toshiba.  The agreement does not require or preclude ACC from paying dividends on a pro-rata basis.  The agreement may be terminated upon the mutual written agreement of the parties, if the distribution agreement is terminated or if either party commences a bankruptcy or similar proceeding.

 

The Company has historically been the exclusive distributor for Toshiba in the United States and Canada.  In connection with the transaction, ACC and Toshiba formalized this distribution arrangement whereby ACC is Toshiba’s exclusive distributor for the sale of Toshiba products in the United States, Canada, Mexico and all countries in the Caribbean and Central and South America through May 29, 2007.  The distribution agreement provides for 30-day payment terms. The distribution agreement established certain annual minimum purchase targets for ACC’s purchase of Toshiba products for each fiscal year during the entire term of the agreement.  In the event that ACC fails to meet the minimum purchase target, Toshiba shall have the right to convert ACC’s exclusive distributorship to a non-exclusive distributorship for the remaining term of the agreement. Also, in accordance with the terms of the stockholders agreement, upon the termination of the distribution agreement in accordance with certain terms of the distribution agreement, Toshiba maintains a put right and the Company a call right, to repurchase all of the shares held by the other party for a price equal to the fair market value of the shares as calculated in accordance with the agreement.  Pursuant to the agreement, the put right is only exercisable if ACC terminates the distribution agreement or if another strategic investor acquires a direct or indirect equity ownership interest in excess of 20% in the Company. The call

 

105



 

right is only exercisable if Toshiba elects to terminate the distribution agreement after its initial five (5) year term.

 

Additionally, ACC entered into an employment agreement with the President and Chief Executive Officer (the Executive) of ACC through May 29, 2007.  Under the agreement, ACC is required to pay the Executive an annual base salary of $500 in addition to an annual bonus equal to 2% of ACC’s annual earnings before income taxes.  The Company, under the employment agreement, was required to establish and pay a bonus of $3,200 to key employees of ACC, including the Executive, to be allocated by the Executive.  The bonus was for services previously rendered and, accordingly, the bonus has been included in general and administrative expenses in the accompanying statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002.  The Executive was required to utilize all or a portion of the bonus allocated to him to repay the remaining outstanding principal and accrued interest owed by the Executive to the Company pursuant to the unsecured promissory note in favor of the Company.  During the year ended November 30, 2002, the Executive was paid $1,800 less an amount outstanding under a promissory note of $651.

 

As a result of the issuance of ACC’s shares, the Company recognized a gain, net of expenses of $1,735, of $14,269 ($8,847 after provision for deferred taxes) during the quarter ended May 31, 2002.  The gain represents the excess of the sale price per share over the carrying amount per share multiplied by the number of shares issued to Toshiba.  The gain on the issuance of the subsidiary’s shares has been recognized in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002 in accordance with the Company’s policy on the recognition of such transactions, which is an allowable method under Staff Accounting Bulleting Topic 5.H.

 

Toshiba’s minority interest income (expense) in ACC included in the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 was ($1,094), $501 and $4,741 , respectively.  Minority interest is included in the pre-tax income (loss) in the segment data.

 

(4)                                  Supplemental Cash Flow Information

 

The following is supplemental information relating to the consolidated statements of cash flows:

 

 

 

 

For the Years Ended November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

Cash paid during the years for:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest, excluding bank charges

 

$

4,870

 

$

3,883

 

$

1,303

 

Income taxes

 

$

21,069

 

$

3,550

 

$

2,478

 

 

106



 

Non-cash Transactions:

 

During 2000, the Company exercised its option to convert 800,000 Japanese yen (approximately $7,595) of Shintom Co. Ltd. (Shintom) convertible debentures (Shintom debentures) into approximately 33,900,000 shares of Shintom common stock, respectively (Note 9).

 

During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company recorded an unrealized holding gain (loss) relating to available-for-sale marketable equity securities, net of deferred income taxes, of $(10,119), $(831) and $422, respectively, as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (Note 19).

 

During 2000,  $535 of its $65,000 6¼% subordinated debentures were converted into 30,170 shares of Class A common stock (Note 15).

 

During 2001, 314,800 warrants were exercised and converted into 314,800 shares of common stock (Note 18(d)).

 

(5)                                  Transactions With Major Suppliers

 

(a)           ACC Dividend

 

In February 2001, the board of directors of  ACC declared a dividend payable to its shareholders, Audiovox Corporation, a then 95% shareholder, and Toshiba, a then 5% shareholder for their respective share of net income for the previous fiscal years.  ACC paid Toshiba its share of the dividend, which approximated $1,034 in the first quarter of 2001.  There were no dividends declared during fiscal 2002.

 

(b)           Sale/Leaseback Transaction

 

In April 2000, AX Japan purchased land and a building (the Property) from Shintom Co., Ltd.  (Shintom) for 770,000,000 Yen (approximately $7,300) and entered into a leaseback agreement whereby Shintom leased the Property from AX Japan for a one-year period.  This lease is being accounted for as an operating lease by AX Japan. Shintom is a stockholder who owns all of the outstanding preferred stock of the Company and is a manufacturer of products purchased by the Company through its previously-owned equity investee, TALK Corporation (TALK).  The Company currently holds stock in Shintom and has previously invested in Shintom convertible debentures (Note 9).

 

The purchase of the Property by AX Japan was financed with a 500,000,000 Yen ($4,671) subordinated loan obtained from Vitec Co., Ltd.  (Vitec), a 150,000,000 Yen loan ($1,397) from Pearl First (Pearl) and a 140,000,000 Yen loan ($1,291) from the Company.  The land and building have been included in property, plant and equipment, and the loans have

 

107



 

been recorded as notes payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 .  Changes arising from the fluctuations in the Yen exchange rate have been reflected as a component of accumulated other comprehensive loss on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Vitec is a major supplier to Shintom, and Pearl is an affiliate of Vitec.  The loans bear interest at 5% per annum, and principle is payable in equal monthly installments over a six-month period beginning six months subsequent to the date of the loans.  The loans from Vitec and Pearl are subordinated completely to the loan from the Company and, in liquidation, the Company receives payment first.

 

Upon the expiration of six months after the transfer of the title to the Property to AX Japan, Shintom had the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan.  This option could be extended for one additional six month period.  The option to repurchase the building is at a price of 770,000,000 Yen plus the equity capital of AX Japan (which in no event can be less than 60,000,000 Yen) and can only be made if Shintom settles any rent due AX Japan pursuant to the lease agreement.  The option to purchase the shares of stock of AX Japan is at a price not less than the aggregate par value of the shares and, subsequent to the purchase of the shares, AX Japan must repay the outstanding loan due to the Company.  If Shintom does not exercise its option to repurchase the Property or the shares of AX Japan, or upon occurrence of certain events, AX Japan can dispose of the Property as it deems appropriate.  The events which result in the ability of AX Japan to be able to dispose of the Property include Shintom petitioning for bankruptcy, failing to honor a check, failing to pay rent, etc.  If Shintom fails, or at any time becomes financially or otherwise unable to exercise its option to repurchase the Property, Vitec has the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan under similar terms as the Shintom options.

 

AX Japan had the option to delay the repayment of the loans for an additional six months if Shintom extended its options to repurchase the Property or stock of AX Japan.  In September 2000, Shintom extended its option to repurchase the Property and AX Japan delayed its repayment of the loans for an additional six months.

 

In March 2001, upon the expiration of the additional six-month period, the Company and Shintom agreed to extend the lease for an additional one-year period.  In addition, Shintom was again given the option to purchase the Property or shares of stock of AX Japan after the expiration of a six-month period or extend the option for one additional six-month period. AX Japan was also given the option to delay the repayment of the loans for an additional six months if Shintom extended its option for an additional six months.

 

In October 2002, the Company sold all of its shares in AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., an unrelated party to the Company.  The purchase price of the shares was 60,000 Yen.  As

 

108



 

a result of this transaction, the purchaser repaid in full 113,563 Yen which represented the full balance of amounts then owed to the Company by AX Japan.  The agreement required the purchaser to immediately change the name of AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., and the Company resigned from all officer and board of directors  positions.  The Company has no further relationship or obligations, whether contingent or direct to RMS Co., Ltd., formerly known as AX Japan. 

 

As a result of  the completion of this transaction, all assets and liabilities of Audiovox Japan have been removed from the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002, specifically  the land and the building and the notes payable for the Vitec Co., Ltd (Vitec) 150,000 Yen loan and the Pearl First (Pearl) a 140,000 Yen loan. As a result of this transaction, the Company recovered in Yen its initial investment in AX Japan as well as its loan to finance the purchase of the land and building.  However, the Company recognized a $338 loss on the sale of its shares in AX Japan, as the sales price was less than the value of the net assets of AX Japan sold to Vitec.  Contributing to the loss on sale were foreign currency loss and other expenses that will not be recovered.  The loss on the sale of the shares of AX Japan has been included in other net on the accompanying consolidated statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002.

 

In connection with the April 2000 transaction, the Company received 100,000,000 Yen ($922) from Shintom for its 2,000 shares of TALK stock.  The Company had the option to repurchase the shares of TALK at a purchase price of 50,000 Yen per share, with no expiration date.  Given the option to repurchase the shares of TALK, the Company did not surrender control over the shares of TALK and, accordingly, had not accounted for this transaction as a sale.  In August 2000, the Company surrendered its option to repurchase the shares of TALK.  As such, the Company recorded a gain on the sale of shares in the amount of $427 in August 2000.

 

(c)           Inventory Purchases - Shintom and TALK

 

The Company engages in transactions with Shintom and TALK. TALK, which holds world-wide distribution rights for product manufactured by Shintom, has given the Company exclusive distribution rights on all wireless personal communication products for all countries except Japan, China, Thailand and several mid-eastern countries.  Through October 2000, the Company  held a 30.8% interest in TALK.  The Company no longer holds an equity interest in TALK.

 

Transactions with Shintom and TALK include financing arrangements and inventory purchases which approximated 7%, 1.5% and 0.7% for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively, of total inventory purchases.  At November 30, 2000, 2001 and

 

109



 

2002, the Company had recorded $1, $331  and $13, respectively, of liability due to TALK for inventory purchases included in accounts payable.  There were no documentary acceptance obligations payable to TALK as of November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002.  At November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had recorded a receivable from TALK in the amount of $3,823, $265 and $0, respectively,  a portion of which is payable with interest (Note 8), which is reflected in receivable from vendors on the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

 

(d)           Inventory Purchases - Other

 

Inventory purchases from two major suppliers approximated 72%, 75% and 67% of total inventory purchases for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  Although there are a limited number of manufacturers of its products, management believes that other suppliers could provide similar products on comparable terms.  A change in suppliers, however, could cause a delay in product availability and a possible loss of sales, which would affect operating results adversely.

 

(6)                                  Business Acquisition

 

On March 15, 2002, Code Systems, Inc. (Code), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Audiovox Electronics Corp., purchased certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc., an automotive security product company.  The results of operations of Code-Alarm, Inc. are included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements from the date of purchase.  The purchase price consisted of approximately $7,100, paid in cash at the closing, and a debenture (CSI Debenture) whose value is linked to the future earnings of Code, however, in accordance with the terms of the agreement, the CSI debenture has an initial estimated value of $40,000.  The payment of any amount under the terms of the CSI Debenture is based on performance and is  scheduled to occur in the first calendar quarter of 2006.  The Company accounted for the transaction in accordance with the purchase method of accounting.  As a result of the transaction, goodwill of $1,854 was recorded.  The allocation of the purchase price is pending the final determination of certain acquired balances.  Any payments made under the terms of the CSI Debenture in the future will be reflected as a component of goodwill.  Proforma results of operations were not provided as the amounts were deemed immaterial to the consolidated financial statements of the Company.

 

Simultaneous with this business acquisition, the Company entered into a purchase and supply agreement with a third party. Under the terms of this agreement, the third party will purchase or direct its suppliers to purchase certain products from the Company.  In exchange for entering into this agreement, the Company issued 50 warrants in its subsidiary, Code, which vest immediately.  These warrants were deemed to have minimal value based upon the current value of Code.   Furthermore, the agreement calls for the issuance of additional warrants based upon the future operating performance of Code.

 

110



 

 

Based upon the contingent nature of these warrants, no recognition was given to these contingent warrants in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

 

111



 

(7)                                  Accounts Receivable

 

Accounts receivable is comprised of the following:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trade accounts receivable and other

 

$

245,289

 

$

195,228

 

Less:

 

 

 

 

 

Allowance for doubtful accounts

 

4,715

 

6,829

 

Allowance for cellular deactivations

 

2,035

 

1,628

 

Allowance for cash discounts

 

182

 

207

 

 

 

$

238,357

 

$

186,564

 

 

(8)                                  Receivable from Vendor

 

The Company recorded receivable from vendor in the amount of $6,828 and $14,174 as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Receivable from vendor represents prepayments on product shipments, defective product reimbursements and interest receivable at a rate of 4.03% at November 30, 2001, on amounts due from TALK (Note 5) and $4,550 at November 30, 2001 for reimbursements for costs incurred by the Company for upgrades that were performed by the Company in 2001 on certain models which Toshiba manufactured.  At November 30, 2002, the Company recorded receivables from Toshiba aggregating approximately $12,219 for price protection and software upgrades.  Subsequent to November 30, 2002 the receivables from Toshiba were paid in full.

 

(9)                                  Investment Securities

 

As of November 30, 2001, the Company’s investment securities consist of $1,933 of available-for-sales marketable securities, which consist primarily of 1,530,000 shares of CellStar Common Stock and 1,904,000 shares of Shintom common stock and trading securities of $3,844, which consist of mutual funds that are held in connection with the deferred compensation plan.  As of November 30, 2002, the Company’s investment securities consist of $1,455 of available-for-sales marketable securities, which relates to 306,000 shares (after a 5 for 1 reverse stock split) of CellStar Common Stock, 1,904,000 shares of Shintom Common Stock and trading securities of $3,949 which consist of mutual funds that are held in connection with the deferred compensation plan.   During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company recorded a $1,158 other-than-temporary impairment of its Shintom common stock.

 

112



 

The cost, gross unrealized gains and losses and aggregate fair value of the investment securities available-for-sale as of November 30, 2001 and 2002 were as follows:

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

Cost

 

Gross
Unrealized
Holding
Gain (Loss)

 

Aggregate
Fair
Value

 

Cost

 

Gross
Unrealized
Holding
Gain (Loss)

 

Other-than-
Temporary
Impairment
Charge

 

Aggregate
Fair
Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CellStar Common Stock

 

$

2,401

 

$

(1,055

)

$

1,346

 

$

2,401

 

$

(966

)

 

$

1,435

 

Shintom Common Stock

 

1,179

 

(592

)

587

 

1,179

 

 

$

(1,158

)

21

 

 

 

$

3,580

 

$

(1,647

)

$

1,933

 

$

3,580

 

$

(966

)

$

(1,158

)

$

1,456

 

 

Related deferred tax assets of $626 and $599 were recorded at November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively, as a reduction to the unrealized holding loss included in accumulated other comprehensive loss.

 

During 2000, the Company exercised its option to convert 800,000 Japanese yen of Shintom debentures into shares of Shintom common stock. The Company sold the Shintom common stock, yielding net proceeds of $12,376 and a gain of $1,850.

 

During 2000, the Company sold 200,000 shares of its CellStar common stock yielding net proceeds of $851 and a gain of $537.

 

During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company recorded a $1,158 other-than-temporary impairment of its Shintom common stock.

 

During 2001 and 2002, the net unrealized holding loss on trading securities that has been included in earnings is $779 and $558, respectively.

 

113



 

(10)                            Property, Plant and Equipment

 

A summary of property, plant and equipment, net, is as follows:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Land

 

$

4,493

 

$

363

 

Buildings

 

4,168

 

1,605

 

Property under capital lease

 

7,246

 

7,142

 

Furniture, fixtures and displays

 

2,129

 

2,404

 

Machinery and equipment

 

6,590

 

8,204

 

Computer hardware and software

 

13,108

 

14,467

 

Automobiles

 

658

 

769

 

Leasehold improvements

 

4,117

 

4,305

 

 

 

42,509

 

39,259

 

Less accumulated depreciation and amortization

 

(16,822

)

(20,878

)

 

 

$

25,687

 

$

18,381

 

 

The amortization of the property under capital lease is included in depreciation and amortization expense.

 

Computer software includes approximately $2,396 and $1,450 of unamortized costs as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively, related to the acquisition and installation of management information systems for internal use.

 

Depreciation and amortization of plant and equipment amounted to $3,426, $4,174 and $4,768 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  Included in accumulated depreciation and amortization is amortization of computer software costs of $702, $776 and $850 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  Included in accumulated depreciation and amortization is amortization of property under capital lease of $240 for each of the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

(11)                            Equity Investments

 

As of November 30, 2002, the Company’s 72% owned subsidiary, Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd., had a 29% ownership interest in Avx Posse (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd. (Posse) which monitors car security commands through a satellite based system in Malaysia.  In addition, the Company had a 20% ownership interest in Bliss-tel which distributes cellular telephones and accessories in Thailand, and the Company had 50% non-controlling ownership interests in three other entities:  Protector

 

114



 

Corporation (Protector) which acts as a distributor of chemical protection treatments; ASA which acts as a distributor to specialized markets for RV’s and van conversions, of televisions and other automotive sound, security and accessory products; and G.L.M. Wireless Communications, Inc. (G.L.M.) which is in the cellular telephone, pager and communications business in the New York metropolitan area.

 

During 2000, the Company entered into an agreement to cease the operations of its 50% owned investment in Audiovox Pacific Pty., Limited, which was a former distributor of cellular telephones and automotive sound and security products in Australia and New Zealand. Also during fiscal 2000, the Company entered into an agreement to transfer to the other equity partner its 50% ownership equity in Quintex West, which is in the cellular telephone and related communication products business, as well as the automotive after-market products business.  No consideration was given or no gain or loss was recorded in connection with either of the above transactions as both equity investments had been previously written down, and the Company had no on-going obligations to the entities or the other equity partner.

 

The Company previously held a 30.8% investment in TALK which was disposed of during fiscal 2000 (Notes 5 and 8).

 

The Company’s net sales to the equity investees amounted to $3,233, $2,656 and $3,504 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  The Company’s purchases from the equity investees amounted to $119,444, $5,592 and $1,883 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  The Company recorded $1,432, $746 and $644 of outside representative commission expenses for activations and residuals generated by G.L.M. on the Company’s behalf during fiscal year 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

Included in accounts receivable at November 30, 2001 and 2002 are trade receivables due from its equity investments aggregating $561 and $817, respectively.  At November 30, 2001 and 2002, included in accounts payable and other accrued expenses were obligations to equity investments aggregating $13 and $6, respectively.

 

For the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, interest income earned on equity investment notes and other receivables approximated $602, $157 and $2, respectively.  Interest expense on documentary acceptances payable to TALK approximated $11 in 2000.

 

The following summary financial information reflects the interest of ASA.  Such summary financial information has been provided herein based upon the individual significance of this unconsolidated equity investment to the consolidated financial information of the Company.  Furthermore, based upon the lack of significance to the consolidated financial information of the Company, no summary financial information for the Company’s other equity investments has been provided herein:

 

115



 

 

 

As of November 30,

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

Current assets

 

$

18,225

 

$

20,533

 

Non-current assets

 

2,395

 

2,332

 

Current liabilities

 

2,794

 

3,447

 

Non-current liabilities

 

 

 

Members’ equity

 

17,826

 

19,418

 

 

 

 

Twelve Months Ended
November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

54,875

 

$

63,336

 

$

44,168

 

Operating income

 

2,617

 

5,581

 

216

 

Net income

 

4,011

 

6,908

 

3,486

 

 

The Company’s share of income from this unconsolidated equity investment for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 was $2,006, $3,454 and $1,743, respectively.

 

(12)                            Unearned Revenue

 

As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet, is $8,314 and $0, respectively, of which represents prepayments for future product shipments.  The Company recognized the revenue as product shipments were made.

 

(13)                            Financing Arrangements

 

(a)                                  Bank Obligations

 

The Company maintains a revolving credit agreement with various financial institutions which expires July 27, 2004.  As of November 30, 2002, the credit agreement provided for $250,000 of available credit (which was subsequently amended on March 13, 2003 to provide for $200,000 of available credit), including $15,000 for foreign currency borrowings.

 

Under the credit agreement, the Company may obtain credit through direct borrowings and letters of credit.  The obligations of the Company under the credit agreement are guaranteed by certain of the Company’s subsidiaries and is secured by accounts receivable, inventory and the Company’s shares of ACC.  As of November 30, 2002, availability of credit under the credit agreement was a maximum aggregate amount of $250,000, subject to certain

 

116



 

conditions, based upon a formula taking into account the amount and quality of its accounts receivable and inventory.  At November 30, 2002, the amount of unused available credit is $102,491.  The credit agreement also allows for commitments of $50,000 in forward exchange contracts.

 

117



 

Outstanding short-term obligations under the credit agreement at November 30, 2001 and 2002 were as follows:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revolving Credit Notes

 

$

13,525

 

$

16,883

 

Eurodollar Notes

 

73,000

 

20,000

 

 

 

$

86,525

 

$

36,883

 

 

Interest rates are as follows: revolving credit notes at Prime Rate at November 30, 2000, 0.25% above the Prime Rate at November 30, 2001 and 0.50% above the Prime Rate at November 30, 2002 which was 9.5%, 5.5% and 4.8% at November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  Eurodollar Notes at 1.25% above Libor at November 30, 2000, 1.75% above Libor at November 30, 2001 and 2.50% above Libor at November 30, 2002 which was 6.8%, 3.4% and 3.9% at November 30, 2000, November 30, 2001 and November 30, 2002, respectively.  The Company pays a commitment fee on the unused portion of the credit line.

 

The credit agreement contains several covenants requiring, among other things, minimum levels of pre-tax income and minimum levels of net worth. Additionally, the agreement includes restrictions and limitations on payments of dividends, stock repurchases and capital expenditures.

 

At May 31, 2001, November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, the Company was not in compliance with certain of its pre-tax income covenants.  Furthermore, as of November 30, 2002, the Company was also not in compliance with the requirement to deliver audited financial statements 90 days after the Company’s fiscal year-end, and as of February 28, 2003, the requirement to deliver unaudited quarterly financial statements 45 days after the Company’s quarter end.  The Company received a waiver for the November 30, 2001 pre-tax income violation subsequent to its issuance of the November 30, 2001 financial statements. In addition, the Company received waivers for the May 31, 2001 and February 28, 2002 violations.

 

The Company has not received waivers for the November 30, 2002 violation of a particular pre-tax income covenant or delivery of audited financial statements 90 days after the Company’s fiscal year-end.  Accordingly, as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company’s outstanding domestic obligations of $86,525 and 36,883, have been classified as current on the accompanying consolidated financial statements, respectively.  Management is in the process of requesting a waiver for the November 30, 2002 and February 28, 2003 violations.  While

 

118



 

the Company was able to obtain waivers for such violations in 2001 and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, there can be no assurance that future negotiations with its lenders would be successful or that the Company will not violate covenants in the future, therefore, resulting in amounts outstanding to be payable upon demand.  Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company repaid its obligation of $36,883 in full resulting in bank obligations outstanding at May 15, 2003 of $0.  This credit agreement has no cross covenants with the other credit facilities described below.

 

The Company also has revolving credit facilities in Malaysia (Malaysian Credit Agreement) to finance additional working capital needs.  As of November 30, 2002, the available line of credit for direct borrowing, letters of credit, bankers’ acceptances and other forms of credit approximated $5,000.  The credit facilities are partially secured by three standby letters of credit of $1,300, $800 and $800 and are payable upon demand or upon expiration of the standby letters of credit on January 15, 2003, August 31, 2003 and August 31, 2003, respectively. The obligations of the Company under the Malaysian Credit Agreement are also secured by the property and building owned by Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd.  Outstanding obligations under the Malaysian Credit Agreement at November 30, 2001 and 2002 were approximately $3,514 and $3,317, respectively.  At November 30, 2001, interest on the credit facility ranged from 6.5% to 7.0%.  At November 30, 2002, interest on the credit facility ranged from 4.75% to 6.0%.

 

As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, Audiovox Venezuela had notes payable of approximately 1,622,834 and 0 Venezuelan Bolivars ($2,074 and $0 at November 30, 2001 and 2002) outstanding to a bank.  Interest on the notes payable was 10.7%.  The notes payable were secured by a standby letter of credit in the amount of $3,500 by the Company and was payable upon demand or upon expiration of the standby letter of credit on May 31, 2002.  The Company has not extended this line of credit as of November 30, 2002.

 

The Company also has a revolving credit facility in Brazil to finance additional working capital needs. The Brazilian credit facility is secured by the Company under a standby letter of credit in the amount of $200, which expires on December 9, 2002 and is payable on demand or upon expiration of the standby letter of credit.  At November 30, 2001 and 2002, outstanding obligations under the credit facility were 254 and 172 Brazilian Bolivars ($100 and $48), respectively, and interest on the credit facility ranged from 19% to 29%.

 

At November 30, 2001, the Company had additional outstanding standby letters of credit aggregating $640 which expire on various dates from May 2003 to July 2003.

 

The maximum month-end amounts outstanding under all bank borrowing facilities during the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were $156,854, $94,291 and $59,222,

 

119



 

respectively.  Average borrowings during the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were $52,010, $49,692 and $21,747, respectively, and the weighted average interest rates were 8.9%, 8.2% and 9.1%, respectively.

 

(b)                                 Documentary Acceptances

 

The Company had various unsecured documentary acceptance lines of credit available with suppliers to finance inventory purchases. The Company does not have written agreements specifying the terms and amounts available under the lines of credit.  There were no documentary acceptances outstanding at November 30, 2001 and 2002.

 

The maximum month-end documentary acceptances outstanding and average borrowings during the year ended November 30, 2002 was $0 and $85,473, respectively.

 

(14)                            Notes Payable

 

A summary of notes payable follows:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

Note payable due to Vitec (Note 5(b))

 

$

4,051

 

 

Note payable due to Pearl (Note 5(b))

 

1,216

 

 

 

 

$

5,267

 

 

 

The notes bear interest at 5% and are payable in equal monthly installments over a six-month period beginning in October 2000.  As a result of the extension of Shintom’s option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan (Note 5(b)), the commencement of repayment was delayed to April 2001 and again to March 2002.  Accordingly, the notes payable have been classified as current in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001.  In connection with the sale of the shares of Audiovox Japan, the notes have been eliminated from the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002.

 

(15)                            Long-Term Debt

 

On March 15, 1994, the Company completed the sale of $65,000, 6¼% subordinated debentures due 2001 and entered into an indenture agreement.  The subordinated debentures were convertible into shares of the Company’s Class A common stock, par value $.01 per share at an initial conversion price of $17.70 per share, subject to adjustment under certain circumstances.  The indenture agreement contained various covenants.  The bonds were subject to redemption by the Company in whole, or in part, at any time after March 15, 1997, at certain specified amounts. On May 9, 1995, the

 

120



 

Company issued warrants to certain beneficial holders of these subordinated debentures.

 

During fiscal 2000, holders of the Company’s $65,000, 6 1/4% subordinated convertible debentures exercised their option to convert $534 debentures for 30,170 shares of the Company’s Class A common stock. As a result of this conversion and the conversions that took place prior to 2000, the remaining subordinated debentures of $486 was included as current installments of long-term debt at November 30, 2000.  During 2001, the Company paid $486 to the remaining holders of the Company’s subordinated convertible debentures as such there is no convertible debentures outstanding at November 30, 2001 or 2002.

 

On October 20, 1994, the Company issued a note payable for 500,000 Japanese Yen to finance its investment in TALK (Note 4(c)).  The note was scheduled to be repaid on October 20, 2004 and bore interest at 4.1%.  The note could be repaid by cash payment or by giving 10,000 shares of its TALK investment to the lender.  The lender had an option to acquire 2,000 shares of TALK held by the Company in exchange for releasing the Company from 20% of the face value of the note at any time after October 20, 1995. In October 2000, the Company exercised its option to repay the note by returning the 10,000 shares of its TALK investment to the lender.  In connection with the transaction, the Company recognized an extraordinary gain in the amount of $2,189 representing the difference between the loan, which approximated $4,578, and the Company’s recorded investment in TALK, which approximated $2,389, at the time of the transaction.

 

On May 29, 2002, Toshiba purchased an additional 20% of ACC.  In connection with the transaction, an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note) was issued to Toshiba.  The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1¾% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003.  The unpaid principle amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest, on May 31, 2007 and automatically renews for an additional five years.  In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a maximum 25% interest in ACC.

 

(16)                            Income Taxes

 

The components of income (loss) before the provision for (recovery of) income taxes are as follows:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Domestic Operations

 

$

39,317

 

$

(11,535

)

$

(7,584

)

Foreign Operations

 

2,826

 

53

 

1,181

 

 

 

$

42,143

 

$

(11,482

)

$

(6,403

)

 

121



 

Total income tax expense (benefit) was allocated as follows:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Statement of operations

 

$

15,766

 

$

(3,627

)

$

12,932

 

Stockholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealized holding gain (loss) on investment securities recognized for financial reporting purposes

 

(6,202

)

(509

)

260

 

Unrealized holding gain (loss) on equity collar recognized for financial reporting purposes

 

570

 

 

 

Income tax benefit of employee stock option exercises

 

(1,270

)

 

(17

)

Total income tax expense (benefit)

 

$

8,864

 

$

(4,136

)

$

13,175

 

 

The provision for (recovery of) income taxes is comprised of:

 

 

 

Federal

 

Foreign

 

State

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2000:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

$

19,210

 

$

656

 

$

1,934

 

$

21,800

 

Deferred

 

(4,481

)

(704

)

(849

)

(6,034

)

 

 

$

14,729

 

$

(48

)

$

1,085

 

$

15,766

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2001:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

$

(1,751

)

$

359

 

$

1,097

 

$

(295

)

Deferred

 

(2,407

)

153

 

(1,078

)

(3,332

)

 

 

$

(4,158

)

$

512

 

$

19

 

$

(3,627

)

2002:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

$

(525

)

$

1,604

 

$

1,949

 

$

3,028

 

Deferred

 

8,645

 

180

 

1,079

 

9,904

 

 

 

$

8,120

 

$

1,784

 

$

3,028

 

$

12,932

 

 

122



 

A reconciliation of the provision for income taxes computed at the Federal statutory rate to income (loss) before income taxes and minority interest and the actual provision for income taxes is as follows:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tax provision at Federal statutory rates

 

$

14,750

 

35.0

%

$

(4,019

)

(35.0%

)

$

(2,241

)

(35.0%

)

State income taxes, net of Federal benefit

 

705

 

1.7

 

12

 

0.1

 

338

 

5.3

 

Increase (decrease) in beginning-of-the-year balance of the valuation allowance for deferred tax assets

 

(1,041

)

(2.5

)

(227

)

(2.0

)

13,090

 

204.4

 

Foreign tax rate differential

 

(59

)

(0.1

)

448

 

4.0

 

1,372

 

21.4

 

Permanent and other, net

 

1,411

 

3.3

 

159

 

1.3

 

373

 

5.9

 

 

 

$

15,766

 

37.4

%

$

(3,627

)

(31.6

)%

$

12,932

 

202.0

%

 

The significant components of deferred income tax (recovery) expense for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002 are as follows:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

 

 

Deferred tax expense (recovery) (exclusive of the effect of other components listed below)

 

$

(3,105

)

$

(3,186

)

Increase (decrease) in beginning-of-the-year balance of the valuation allowance for deferred tax assets

 

(227

)

13,090

 

 

 

$

(3,332

)

$

9,904

 

 

123



 

The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets and deferred liabilities are presented below:

 

 

 

November 30,

 

 

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets:

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable, principally due to allowance for doubtful accounts and cellular deactivations

 

$

1,971

 

$

1,723

 

Inventory, principally due to additional costs capitalized for tax purposes pursuant to the Tax Reform Act of 1986

 

1,043

 

1,617

 

Inventory, principally due to valuation reserve

 

5,421

 

7,521

 

Accrual for future warranty costs

 

3,241

 

3,249

 

Plant, equipment and certain intangibles, principally due to depreciation and amortization

 

1,442

 

1,863

 

Net operating loss carryforwards, federal, state and foreign

 

870

 

4,926

 

Foreign tax credits

 

 

1,347

 

Accrued liabilities not currently deductible and other

 

746

 

520

 

Investment securities

 

463

 

719

 

Deferred compensation plans

 

1,492

 

1,537

 

Total gross deferred tax assets

 

16,689

 

25,022

 

Less: valuation allowance

 

(116

)

(13,206

)

Net deferred tax assets

 

16,573

 

11,816

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

Issuance of subsidiary shares

 

(1,460

)

(6,867

)

Total gross deferred tax liabilities

 

(1,460

)

(6,867

)

Net deferred tax asset

 

$

15,113

 

$

4,949

 

 

The net change in the total valuation allowance for the year ended November 30, 2002 was an increase of $13,090, primarily resulting from a valuation allowance recorded on certain of ACC’s deferred tax assets.  After this valuation allowance, the net deferred tax assets remaining on the consolidated balance sheet represent deferred tax assets generated from the Electronics Group.

 

A valuation allowance is provided when it is more likely than not that some portion, or all, of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.  Based on the Electronics Group’s ability to carry back future reversals of deferred tax assets to taxes paid in current and prior years and the Electronics Group’s historical taxable income record, adjusted for unusual items, management believes it is more likely

 

124



 

than not that the Electronics Group will realize the benefit of the net deferred tax assets existing at November 30, 2002.  Further, management believes the existing net deductible temporary differences will reverse during periods in which the Electronics Group generates net taxable income.  There can be no assurance, however, that the Company will generate any earnings or any specific level of continuing earnings in the future.  The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realizable by the Electronics Group, therefore, could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced.

 

At November 30, 2002, the Wireless Group had a net operating loss carryforward for federal income tax purposes of approximately $7,468, which is available to offset future taxable income, if any, which will expire through the year ended November 30, 2022.

 

(17)                            Capital Structure

 

The Company’s capital structure is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

Shares Authorized

 

Shares
Outstanding

 

Voting
Rights

 

 

 

 

 

Par

 

November 30,

 

November 30,

 

Per

 

Liquidation

 

Security

 

Value

 

2001

 

2002

 

2001

 

2002

 

Share

 

Rights

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred Stock

 

$

50.00

 

50,000

 

50,000

 

50,000

 

50,000

 

 

$50 per share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Series Preferred Stock

 

0.01

 

1,500,000

 

1,500,000

 

 

 

 

 

Class A Common Stock

 

0.01

 

60,000,000

 

60,000,000

 

19,706,309

 

19,559,445

 

One

 

Ratably with Class B

 

Class B Common Stock

 

0.01

 

10,000,000

 

10,000,000

 

2,260,954

 

2,260,954

 

Ten

 

Ratably with Class A

 

 

The holders of Class A and Class B common stock are entitled to receive cash or property dividends declared by the Board of Directors.  The Board can declare cash dividends for Class A common stock in amounts equal to or greater than the cash dividends for Class B common stock.  Dividends other than cash must be declared equally for both classes.  Each share of Class B common stock may, at any time, be converted into one share of Class A common stock.

 

The 50,000 shares of non-cumulative Preferred Stock outstanding are owned by Shintom (see Notes 5 and 9) and have preference over both classes of common stock in the event of liquidation or

 

125



 

dissolution.

 

The Company’s Board of Directors approved the repurchase of 1,563,000 shares of the Company’s Class A common stock in the open market under a share repurchase program (the Program).  As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, 909,537 and 1,072,737 shares, respectively, were repurchased under the Program at an average price of $8.12 and $7.93 per share, respectively, for an aggregate amount of $7,386 and $8,511, respectively.

 

As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, 2,916,653 and 2,900,317 shares of the Company’s Class A common stock are reserved for issuance under the Company’s Stock Option and Restricted Stock Plans. There were no convertible securities or warrants outstanding for the Company at November 30, 2001 and 2002 (Notes 15 and 18(d)).  Warrants are outstanding that may be converted into shares of Code (Note 6).

 

In February 2000, the Company sold, pursuant to an underwritten public offering, 2,300,000 shares of its Class A common stock at a price of $45.00 per share.  The Company received $96,573 in net proceeds after deducting underwriting commission and offering expenses.  The net proceeds from the offering were used to repay a portion of amounts outstanding under the revolving credit facility.

 

On April 6, 2000, the stockholders approved a proposal to amend the Company’s Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of authorized shares of Class A common stock, par value $.01, from 30,000,000 to 60,000,000.

 

Undistributed earnings from equity investments included in retained earnings amounted to $3,742 and $4,496 at November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

(18)                            Stock-Based Compensation and Retirement Plans

 

(a)                                  Stock Options

 

The Company has stock option plans under which employees and non-employee directors may be granted incentive stock options (ISO’s) and non-qualified stock options (NQSO’s) to purchase shares of Class A common stock.  Under the plans, the exercise price of the ISO’s will not be less than the market value of the Company’s Class A common stock or greater than 110% of the market value of the Company’s Class A common stock on the date of grant.  The exercise price of the NQSO’s may not be less than 50% of the market value of the Company’s Class A common stock on the date of grant. The options must be exercisable no later than ten years after the date of grant.  The vesting requirements are

 

126



 

determined by the Board of Directors at the time of grant.

 

Compensation expense is recorded with respect to the options based upon the quoted market value of the shares and the exercise provisions at the date of grant.  No compensation expense was recorded for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002.

 

127



 

Information regarding the Company’s stock options is summarized below:

 

 

 

Number
of Shares

 

Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding at November 30, 1999

 

2,871,200

 

11.41

 

Granted

 

 

 

Exercised

 

(121,300

)

6.84

 

Canceled

 

 

 

Outstanding at November 30, 2000

 

2,749,900

 

11.61

 

Granted

 

 

 

Exercised

 

(10,000

)

7.69

 

Canceled

 

 

 

Outstanding at November 30, 2001

 

2,739,900

 

11.62

 

Granted

 

 

 

Exercised

 

(16,336

)

7.69

 

Canceled

 

(12,500

)

13.75

 

Outstanding at November 30, 2002

 

2,711,064

 

11.64

 

Options exercisable at November 30, 2002

 

2,711,064

 

11.64

 

 

At November 30, 2001 and 2002, 176,753 and 189,253 shares, respectively, were available for future grants under the terms of these plans.

 

There were no options granted during 2000, 2001 and 2002.

 

The Company applies APB No. 25 in accounting for its stock option grants and, accordingly, no compensation cost has been recognized in the financial statements for its stock options which have an exercise price equal to or greater than the fair value of the stock on the date of the grant.  Had the Company determined compensation cost based on the fair value at the grant date for its stock options under Statement 123, the Company’s net income (loss) and net income (loss) per common share would have been reduced to the pro-forma amounts indicated below:

 

128



 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

Restated

 

Restated

 

 

 

Net income (loss):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As reported

 

$

27,492

 

$

(7,198

)

$

(14,040

)

Stock based compensation expense

 

4,434

 

2,287

 

864

 

Pro-forma

 

$

23,058

 

$

(9,485

)

$

(14,904

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As reported

 

$

1.29

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.64

)

Pro-forma

 

1.08

 

(0.43

)

(0.68

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As reported

 

$

1.22

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.64

)

Pro-forma

 

1.02

 

(0.43

)

(0.68

)

 

Pro-forma net income (loss) reflect only options granted after November 30, 1995.  Therefore, the full impact of calculating compensation cost for stock options under Statement 123 is not reflected in the pro-forma net income (loss) amounts presented above because compensation cost is reflected over the options’ vesting period and compensation cost for options granted prior to December 1, 1995 was not considered.  Therefore, the pro-forma net income (loss) may not be representative of the effects on reported net income (loss) for future years.

 

Summarized information about stock options outstanding as of November 30, 2002 is as follows:

 

 

 

Outstanding

 

Exercisable

 

Exercise
Price
Range

 

Number
of Shares

 

Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
of Shares

 

Weighted
Average
Life
Remaining
In Years

 

Number
of
Shares

 

Weighted
Average
Price
of Shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$4.63 - $8.00

 

1,122,864

 

$

7.21

 

4.21

 

1,122,864

 

$

7.21

 

$8.01 - $13.00

 

108,200

 

$

11.61

 

2.34

 

108,200

 

$

11.61

 

$13.01 - $15.00

 

1,480,000

 

$

15.00

 

6.78

 

1,480,000

 

$

15.00

 

 

129



 

(b)                                 Restricted Stock Plan

 

The Company has restricted stock plans under which key employees and directors may be awarded restricted stock. Total restricted stock outstanding, granted under these plans, at November 30, 1999 was 13,750.  There were no restricted stock outstanding at November 30, 2000.  Awards under the restricted stock plan may be performance-accelerated shares or performance-restricted shares. During fiscal 2000, 6,825 performance-accelerated shares and 4,846 performance-restricted shares were granted. During fiscal 2000, 1,979 performance-restricted shares lapsed (were not earned).  There were no performance-restricted accelerated shares or performance-restricted shares granted in 2001 and 2002.

 

Compensation expense for the performance-accelerated shares is recorded based upon the quoted market value of the shares on the date of grant.  Compensation expense for the performance-restricted shares is recorded based upon the quoted market value of the shares on the balance sheet date. Compensation expense (income) for these grants for the year ended November 30, 2000 was $40.

 

(c)                                  Employee Stock Purchase Plan

 

In April 2000, the stockholders approved the 2000 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.  The stock purchase plan provides eligible employees an opportunity to purchase shares of the Company’s Class A common stock through payroll deductions at a minimum of 2% and a maximum of 15% of base salary compensation.  Amounts withheld are used to purchase Class A common stock on the open market.  The cost to the employee for the shares is equal to 85% of the fair market value of the shares on or about the quarterly purchase date (December 31, March 31, June 30 or September 30).  The Company bears the cost of the remaining 15% of the fair market value of the shares as well as any broker fees. This Plan provides for purchases of up to 1,000,000 shares.

The Company’s employee stock purchase plan is a compensatory plan, in accordance with APB No. 25, “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees”, for which the related expense is recorded in the consolidated statement of operations.  Accordingly, there would be no impact to the Company’s proforma information in accordance with SFAS 123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation” (Note 18(a)).

 

(d)                                 Stock Warrants

 

At November 30, 2000, 344,800 warrants, convertible into Class A Common Stock at $7 1/8, subject to adjustment under certain circumstances, were outstanding.  During 2001, 314,800 warrants were exercised and converted into 314,800 shares of common stock.  The remaining 30,000 warrants expired in 2001.

 

130



 

(e)                                  Stock Appreciation Units

 

In May 2002, the Company granted seven stock appreciation units in ACC to its Chief Executive Officer.  Each unit has a value of approximately $774, which was based upon the then fair value per share of ACC based upon the value of shares sold to Toshiba (Note 3).

 

Each stock appreciation unit equals the value of one ACC share.  All of these units vested upon the date of grant, however, all of these units are contingent upon the following future events (i) an initial public offering of ACC or (ii) a change of control of ACC as defined.  Further, as these specified events were not considered probable at the grant date, fixed award accounting was followed.

 

(f)                                    Profit Sharing Plans

 

The Company has established two non-contributory employee profit sharing plans for the benefit of its eligible employees in the United States and Canada.  The plans are administered by trustees appointed by the Company.  Accruals for contributions of $1,000 and $300 were recorded by the Company for the United States plan in fiscal 2000 and 2001, respectively.  No accruals for contributions were recorded by the Company in fiscal 2002.  Contributions required by law to be made for eligible employees in Canada were not material.

 

(g)                                 Deferred Compensation Plan

 

Effective December 1, 1999, the Company adopted a Deferred Compensation Plan (the Plan) for a select group of management.  The Plan is intended to provide certain executives with supplemental retirement benefits as well as to permit the deferral of more of their compensation than they are permitted to defer under the Profit Sharing and 401(k) Plan.  The Plan provides for a matching contribution equal to 25% of the employee deferrals up to $20.  The Plan is not intended to be a qualified plan under the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code.  All compensation deferred under the Plan is held by the Company in an investment trust which is considered an asset of the Company.  The investments, which amounted to $3,949 at November 30, 2002, have been classified as trading securities and are included in investment securities on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002.  The return on these underlying investments will determine the amount of earnings credited to the employees.  The Company has the option of amending or terminating the Plan at any time.  The deferred compensation liability is reflected as a long-term liability on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002.  Compensation expense and investment income are recorded in the accompanying consolidated statement

 

131



 

of operations in connection with this deferred compensation plan.

 

(19)                            Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 

The change in net unrealized gain (loss) on marketable securities of $(10,119), $(831) and $422 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 is net of tax of $(6,202), $(509) and $260, respectively.  A reclassification adjustment, net of tax, of $1,480 is included in the net unrealized gain (loss) on marketable securities for the year ended November 30, 2000 and was transferred from other comprehensive income (loss) to gain on sale of investments on the accompanying consolidated statement of operations.  There were no reclassification adjustments for the year ended November 30, 2001 and 2002.

 

The currency translation adjustments are not adjusted for income taxes as they relate to indefinite investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries and equity investments.

 

(20)                            Net Income (Loss) Per Common Share

 

A reconciliation between the numerators and denominators of the basic and diluted earnings (loss)  per common share is as follows:

 

 

 

For the Years Ended
November 30,

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

Net income (loss) (numerator for net income per common share, basic)

 

$

27,492

 

$

(7,198

)

$

(14,040

)

Interest on 6¼% convertible subordinated debentures, net of tax

 

28

 

5

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) (numerator for net income per common share, diluted)

 

$

27,520

 

$

(7,203

)

$

(14,040

)

Weighted average common shares (denominator for net income (loss) per common share, basic)

 

21,393,566

 

21,877,100

 

21,850,035

 

Effect of dilutive securities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Employee stock options and stock warrants

 

1,129,896

 

 

 

Employee stock grants

 

 

 

 

Convertible debentures

 

42,344

 

 

 

Weighted average common and potential common shares outstanding (denominator for net income (loss)  per common share, diluted)

 

22,565,806

 

21,877,100

 

21,850,035

 

Net income (loss) per common share before extraordinary item and cumulative effect:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

1.19

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.65

)

Diluted

 

$

1.12

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.65

)

Net income (loss) per common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

1.29

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.64

)

Diluted

 

$

1.22

 

$

(0.33

)

$

(0.64

)

 

132



 

Employee stock options and stock warrants totaling 2,173,000 and 2,595,108 for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002 were not included in the net income (loss) per common share calculation because their effect would have been anti-dilutive.

 

(21)                            Lease Obligations

 

During 1998, the Company entered into a 30-year lease for a building with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer.  A significant portion of the lease payments, as required under the lease agreement, consists of the debt service payments required to be made by the principal stockholder in connection with the financing of the construction of the building. For financial reporting purposes, the lease has been classified as a capital lease, and, accordingly, a building and the related obligation of approximately $6,340 was recorded (Note 24).  The effective interest rate on the capital lease obligation is 8.0%.

 

133



 

During 1998, the Company entered into a sale/lease back transaction with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer for $2,100 of equipment.  No gain or loss on the transaction was recorded as the book value of the equipment equaled the fair market value. The lease is for five years with monthly rental payments of $34.  The lease has been classified as an operating lease.

 

At November 30, 2002, the Company was obligated under non-cancelable capital and operating leases for equipment and warehouse facilities for minimum annual rental payments as follows:

 

 

 

Capital
Lease

 

Operating
Leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2003

 

$

554

 

$

1,983

 

2004

 

553

 

1,246

 

2005

 

552

 

1,113

 

2006

 

561

 

821

 

2007

 

577

 

628

 

Thereafter

 

11,409

 

889

 

Total minimum lease payments

 

14,206

 

$

6,680

 

Less:  amount representing interest

 

8,010

 

 

 

Present value of net minimum lease payments

 

6,196

 

 

 

Less: current installments included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities

 

55

 

 

 

Long-term obligation

 

$

6,141

 

 

 

 

Rental expense for the above-mentioned operating lease agreements and other leases on a month-to-month basis approximated $2,642, $2,958 and $3,191 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively.

 

The Company leases certain facilities and equipment from its principal stockholder and several officers.  Rentals for such leases are considered by management of the Company to approximate prevailing market rates.  At November 30, 2002, minimum annual rental payments on these related party leases, in addition to the capital lease payments, which are included in the above table, are as follows:

 

2003

 

$

961

 

2004

 

307

 

2005

 

322

 

2006

 

333

 

2007

 

343

 

Thereafter

 

473

 

 

134



 

(22)                            Financial Instruments

 

(a)                                  Off-Balance Sheet Risk

 

Commercial letters of credit are issued by the Company during the ordinary course of business through major domestic banks as requested by certain suppliers.  The Company also issues standby letters of credit principally to secure certain bank obligations of Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd. and Audiovox Venezuela (Note 13(a)).  The Company had open commercial letters of credit of approximately $37,635 and $8,129, of which $16,834 and $3,740 were accrued for purchases incurred as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively.  The terms of these letters of credit are all less than one year.  No material loss is anticipated due to nonperformance by the counter parties to these agreements.  The fair value of these open commercial and standby letters of credit is estimated to be the same as the contract values based on the nature of the fee arrangements with the issuing banks.

 

The Company is a party to joint and several guarantees on behalf of G.L.M. which aggregate $300. There is no market for these guarantees and they were issued without explicit cost. Therefore, it is not practicable to establish its fair value.

 

(b)                                 Concentrations of Credit Risk

 

Financial instruments, which potentially subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk, consist principally of trade receivables.  The Company’s customers are located principally in the United States and Canada and consist of, among others, wireless carriers and service providers, distributors, agents, mass merchandisers, warehouse clubs and independent retailers.

 

At November 30, 2001 and 2002, one customer, a wireless carrier and service provider, accounted for approximately 28% and 27% of accounts receivable, respectively.

 

During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, one customer accounted for approximately 50.5%, 35% and 24% of the Company’s 2000, 2001 and 2002 sales, respectively.

 

The Company generally grants credit based upon analyses of its customers’ financial position and previously established buying and payment patterns.  The Company establishes collateral rights in accounts receivable and inventory and obtains personal guarantees from certain customers based upon management’s credit evaluation.

 

135



 

A portion of the Company’s customer base may be susceptible to downturns in the retail economy, particularly in the consumer electronics industry.  Additionally, customers specializing in certain automotive sound, security and accessory products may be impacted by fluctuations in automotive sales.

 

(c)                                  Fair Value

 

The carrying value of all financial instruments classified as a current asset or liability is deemed to approximate fair value because of the short term maturity of these instruments. The estimated fair value of the Company’s financial instruments is as follows:

 

 

 

November 30, 2001

 

November 30, 2002

 

 

 

Carrying
Amount

 

Fair
Value

 

Carrying
Amount

 

Fair
Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities

 

$

5,777

 

$

5,777

 

$

5,405

 

$

5,405

 

Long-term obligations

 

$

86,525

 

$

86,525

 

$

36,883

 

$

36,883

 

 

The following methods and assumptions were used to estimate the fair value of each class of financial instruments for which it is practicable to estimate that value:

 

Investment Securities

 

The carrying amount represents fair value, which is based upon quoted market prices at the reporting date (Note 9).

 

Long-Term Obligations

 

The carrying amount of bank debt under the Company’s revolving credit agreement approximates fair value because the interest rate on the bank debt is reset every quarter to reflect current market rates.

 

Limitations

 

Fair value estimates are made at a specific point in time, based on relevant market information and information about the financial instrument.  These estimates are subjective in nature and involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment and, therefore, cannot be determined with precision. Changes in assumptions could significantly affect the estimates.

 

136



 

(23)                            Segment Information

 

The Company has two reportable segments which are organized by products:  Wireless and Electronics. The Wireless segment markets wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers.  The Electronics segment sells autosound, mobile electronics and consumer electronics, primarily to mass merchants, specialty retailers, new car dealers, original equipment manufacturers (OEM), independent installers of automotive accessories and the U.S. military.

 

The Company evaluates performance of the segments based upon income before provision for income taxes.  The accounting policies of the segments are the same as those described in the summary of significant accounting policies (Note 1).  The Company allocates interest and certain shared expenses, including treasury, legal and human resources, to the segments based upon estimated usage.  Intersegment sales are reflected at cost and have been eliminated in consolidation.  A royalty fee on the intersegment sales, which is eliminated in consolidation, is recorded by the segments and included in other income (expense).  Certain items are maintained at the Company’s corporate headquarters (Corporate) and are not allocated to the segments.  They primarily include costs associated with accounting and certain executive officer salaries and bonuses and certain items including investment securities, equity investments, deferred income taxes, certain portions of excess cost over fair value of assets acquired, jointly-used fixed assets and debt.  The jointly-used fixed assets are the Company’s management information systems, which is jointly used by the Wireless and Electronics segments and Corporate.  A portion of the management information systems costs, including depreciation and amortization expense, are allocated to the segments based upon estimates made by management.  Segment identifiable assets are those which are directly used in or identified to segment operations.

 

During the year ended November 30, 2000, one customer of the Wireless segment accounted for approximately 50.5% of the Company’s 2000 sales.  During the year ended November 30, 2001, one customer of the Wireless segment accounted for approximately 35.0% of the Company’s 2001 sales.  During the year ended November 30, 2002, one customer of the Wireless segment accounted for approximately 24% of the Company’s consolidated 2002 sales.  No customers in the Electronics segment exceeded 10% of consolidated sales in fiscal 2000, 2001 or 2002.

 

137



 

 

 

Wireless

 

Electronics

 

Corporate

 

Consolidated
Totals

 

2000, As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

1,393,820

 

276,471

 

 

1,670,291

 

Intersegment sales (purchases), net

 

302

 

(302

)

 

 

Interest income

 

198

 

104

 

1,314

 

1,616

 

Interest expense

 

7,752

 

2,551

 

(4,729

)

5,574

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

789

 

1,285

 

2,054

 

4,128

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income tax, minority interest, and extraordinary item

 

30,219

 

16,632

 

(4,708

)

42,143

 

Extraordinary item

 

 

 

2,189

 

2,189

 

Total assets

 

312,593

 

138,827

 

66,166

 

517,586

 

Goodwill, net

 

 

426

 

4,648

 

5,074

 

Non-cash items:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for bad debt expense

 

1,946

 

758

 

(185

)

2,519

 

Deferred income tax (benefit)

 

 

 

6,034

 

(6,034

)

Minority interest

 

 

 

3,555

 

3,555

 

Capital expenditures

 

1,241

 

1,890

 

9,944

 

13,075

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2001, As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

978,888

 

297,703

 

 

1,276,591

 

Interest income

 

138

 

91

 

441

 

670

 

Interest expense

 

7,711

 

2,039

 

(4,575

)

5,175

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

878

 

1,408

 

2,190

 

4,476

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income tax, minority interest, and extraordinary item

 

(17,656

)

13,623

 

(7,449

)

(11,482

)

Total assets

 

347,393

 

138,779

 

58,325

 

544,497

 

Goodwill, net

 

 

370

 

4,362

 

4,732

 

Non-cash items:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for bad debt expense

 

629

 

1,091

 

216

 

1,936

 

Deferred income tax (benefit)

 

 

 

(3,332

)

(3,332

)

Minority interest

 

 

 

1,830

 

1,830

 

Capital expenditures

 

1,082

 

992

 

795

 

2,869

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

727,658

 

372,724

 

 

1,100,382

 

Interest income

 

81

 

169

 

259

 

509

 

Interest expense

 

3,984

 

1,605

 

(2,409

)

3,180

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

1,114

 

1,571

 

2,095

 

4,780

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income tax, minority interest, and cumulative effect

 

(24,906

)

17,415

 

1,088

 

(6,403

)

Total assets

 

304,337

 

209,231

 

37,667

 

551,235

 

Goodwill, net

 

 

2,224

 

4,602

 

6,826

 

Non-cash items:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for bad debt expense

 

3,482

 

1,402

 

 

4,884

 

Deferred income tax expense

 

 

 

9,904

 

9,904

 

Minority interest

 

 

 

4,616

 

4,616

 

Capital expenditures

 

1,093

 

1,321

 

745

 

3,159

 

 

In accordance with SFAS No. 142, Corporate wrote-off its unamortized negative goodwill of $240 as of the date of adoption, which has been reflected in the consolidated statements of operations as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle for the year ended November 30, 2002.  The implementation of SFAS No. 142 was immaterial to the segments.

 

138



 

Goodwill in the amount of $284 was acquired in March 2002 in connection with the purchase of certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc. by Code Systems, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Audiovox Electronics Corp. (Note 6).

 

139



 

Net sales and long-lived assets by location for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were as follows.

 

 

 

Net Sales

 

Long-Lived Assets

 

 

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

2000

 

2001

 

2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

United States

 

$

1,424,077

 

$

1,061,853

 

$

867,154

 

$

43,541

 

$

34,820

 

$

40,506

 

Canada

 

68,004

 

85,796

 

143,368

 

 

 

 

Argentina

 

17,888

 

2,684

 

985

 

 

 

 

Peru

 

 

4,148

 

313

 

 

 

 

Portugal

 

7,679

 

 

 

 

 

 

Japan

 

 

 

 

7,387

 

6,545

 

 

Malaysia

 

15,294

 

12,570

 

11,637

 

849

 

1,220

 

1,038

 

Venezuela

 

15,264

 

22,422

 

16,744

 

644

 

8,339

 

852

 

Mexico, Central America and Caribbean

 

100,599

 

77,134

 

28,655

 

 

 

 

Chile

 

15,794

 

1,077

 

21,711

 

 

 

 

Other foreign countries

 

5,692

 

8,907

 

9,815

 

 

 

 

Total

 

$

1,670,291

 

$

1,276,591

 

$

1,100,382

 

$

52,421

 

$

50,924

 

$

42,396

 

 

(24)                            Related Party Transactions

 

During 2000, the Company advanced $620 to an officer/director of the Company which has been included in prepaid expenses and other current assets on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 and obtained an unsecured note.  The note was paid in full during fiscal 2002.  In addition, the Company has outstanding notes due from various officers of the Company aggregating $235 as of November 30, 2002, which have been included in prepaid and other current assets on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet.  The notes bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus 0.5% per annum.  Principle and interest are payable in equal annual installments beginning July 1, 1999 through July 1, 2003.

 

The Company also leases certain facilities and equipment from its principal stockholder and several officers (Note 21).

 

In April 2000, the Company entered into a sale/leaseback transaction with Shintom (Note 5(b)).

 

Toshiba was a 5% stockholder in ACC (Note 5).  During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, 48%, 34% and 38% of the Company’s purchases, respectively, were from Toshiba (Note 5).  During the quarter ended November 30, 2001, the Company recorded a receivable in

 

140



 

the amount of $4,550 from Toshiba for upgrades that were performed by the Company in 2001 on certain models which Toshiba manufactured. Subsequent to November 30, 2001, the amount was received in full.  At November 30, 2002, the Company recorded receivables from Toshiba aggregating approximately $12,219 for price protection and software upgrades. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the amounts were paid in full.

 

At November 30, 2002, the Company had on hand 504,200 units in the amount of $91,226, which has been recorded in inventory and accounts payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet.  Of this accounts payable, $56,417 is subject to an arrangement with the manufacturer of the phones, which provides for, among other things, extended payment terms.  The payment terms are such that the payable is non-interest bearing, and the Company is not required to pay for the phones until shipment has been made to the Company’s customers.  The remaining $34,809 of the $91,226 accounts payable is payable in accordance with the terms established in a distribution agreement with the vendor, which is 30 days. For certain inventory items, the Company is entitled to receive price protection in the event the selling price to its customers is less than the purchase price from the manufacturer.  The Company records such price protection, as necessary, at the time of the sale of the units.  As of November 30, 2002, such price protection amounted to $32,643, of which $27,683 was recorded as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory was sold.  The other $4,960 in price protection for 2002 has been reflected as a reduction to the remaining inventory cost.

 

On May 29, 2002, Toshiba purchased an additional 20% of ACC for $23,900 in cash, bringing Toshiba’s total ownership interest in ACC to 25%.  In addition, an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note) was issued to Toshiba.  The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1¾% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003.  The unpaid principle amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest, on May 31, 2007 and automatically renews for an additional five years.  In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a maximum 25% interest in ACC.

 

In connection with the transaction, ACC and Toshiba formalized a distribution agreement whereby ACC will be Toshiba’s exclusive distributor for the sale of Toshiba products in the United States, Canada, Mexico and all countries in the Caribbean and Central and South America through May 29, 2007.  Also, in accordance with the terms of the stockholders agreement, upon the termination of the distribution agreement in accordance with certain terms of the distribution agreement.  Pursuant to the agreement, the put right is only exercisable if ACC terminates the distribution agreement or if another strategic investor acquires a direct or indirect equity ownership interest in excess of 20% in the Company.  Toshiba maintains a put right and the Company a call right, to repurchase all of the shares held by the other party for a price equal to the fair market value of the shares as calculated

 

141



 

in accordance with the agreement. Audiovox’s call right is only exercisable if Toshiba elects to terminate the distribution agreement after its initial five (5) year term.

 

The Company engages in transactions with Shintom and TALK (Note 5).

 

(25)                            Commitments and Contingencies

 

Contingencies

 

The Company is currently, and has in the past been, a party to routine litigation incidental to its business.  From time to time, the Company receives notification of alleged violations of registered patent holders’ rights.  The Company has either been indemnified by its manufacturers in these matters,  obtained the benefit of a patent license, or has decided to vigorously defend such claims. For one such patent claim, the Company has recorded an accrual of approximately $496 which represents a settlement offer that has been put forward by the Company to settle this matter.  However, the Company can give no assurances that this particular legal matter can be settled for this amount.  On November 6, 2002, Audiovox Electronics Corporation (“AEC”) was served with a summons and complaint in an action for patent infringement that was instituted by a certain party against AEC in the United State District Court for the Southern District of New York.  The complaint seeks equitable relief and damages for alleged infringement of a patent.  AEC has meritorious defenses to this claim and intends to vigorously defend this action.  However, the Company cannot be certain of the outcome of this matter.

 

Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company and Audiovox Communications Corp. (“ACC”), along with other manufacturers of wireless phones and cellular service providers, were named as defendants in two class action lawsuits alleging non-compliance with FCC ordered emergency 911 call processing capabilities.   There are various procedural motions pending and no discovery has been conducted to date.  These lawsuits have been consolidated and transferred to the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois.  The Company and ACC intend to vigorously defend this matter.  However, no assurances regarding the outcome of this matter can be given at this point in the litigation. 

 

Also, subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company was named in a class action lawsuit alleging non-compliance with emergency 911 call processing capabilities. The Company intends to defend itself vigorously in this matter.  However, no assurances regarding the outcome of this matter can be given at this time. 

 

During 2001, the Company, along with other suppliers, manufacturers and distributors of hand-held wireless telephones, was named as a defendant in five class action lawsuits alleging damages relating

 

142



 

to exposure to radio frequency radiation from hand-held wireless telephones.  These class actions have been consolidated and transferred to a Multi-District Litigation Panel before the United States District Court of the District of Maryland.  On March 5, 2003, Judge Catherine C. Blake of the United States District Court for the District of Maryland granted the defendants’ consolidated motion to dismiss these complaints.  Plaintiffs have appealed to the United States Circuit Court of Appeals, Fourth Circuit.  It is anticipated that the appeal will be heard in late 2003 or early 2004.

 

There are various procedural motions pending and no discovery has been conducted to date. The Company has asserted indemnification claims against the manufacturers of the hand-held wireless telephones. The Company is vigorously defending these class action lawsuits.

 

In July 2002, Audiovox Communications Corp. instituted suit against Northcoast Communications, LLC in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of Suffolk seeking recovery of the sum of $1,818 as the balance due it for cellular telephones sold and delivered.  In its answer Northcoast interposed counterclaims including fraud, negligent misrepresentation and breach of contract seeking damages in excess of $10,000.  The parties have recently served discovery demands and no depositions have been taken to date.  Based on discussions with management and review of Audiovox’s documents, Northcoast’s counterclaims appear to be without merit and interposed to avoid payment of the underlying indebtedness.

 

The Company is the subject of an administrative agency investigation involving alleged reimbursement of a fixed nominal amount of federal campaign contributions during the years 1995 through 1996.  The Company has fully cooperated with the investigation and believes that it has committed no wrongdoing.

 

The Company does not expect the outcome of any pending litigation, separately and in the aggregate, to have a material adverse effect on its business, consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

Commitments

 

The Company has guaranteed a $300 line of credit with a financial institution on behalf of one of its equity investments and has established standby letters of credit to guarantee the bank obligations of Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd. and Audiovox Venezuela (Note 13(a)).

 

(26)                           

class=Section3>

Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data - As Restated

 

Selected unaudited, quarterly financial data of the Company for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002 appears below:

 

143



 

 

 

QUARTER ENDED

 

(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)

 

Feb. 28

 

May 31

 

Aug. 31

 

Nov. 30

 

 

 

(As Restated)

 

(As Restated)

 

(As Restated)

 

(As Restated)

 

2001

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

348,047

 

276,581

 

310,811

 

341,152

 

Gross profit

 

23,861

 

5,393

 

24,001

 

18,135

 

Operating expenses

 

18,913

 

18,997

 

21,470

 

21,246

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest

 

5,552

 

(13,891

)

1,248

 

(4,393

)

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

2,029

 

(5,024

)

540

 

(1,169

)

Minority interest income (expense)

 

(170

)

562

 

121

 

147

 

Net income (loss)

 

3,353

 

(8,305

)

829

 

(3,077

)

Net income (loss) per common share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

0.15

 

(0.38

)

0.04

 

(0.14

)

Diluted

 

0.15

 

(0.38

)

0.04

 

(0.14

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

QUARTER ENDED

 

(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)

 

Feb. 28

 

May 31

 

Aug. 31

 

Nov. 30

 

 

 

(As Restated)

 

(As Restated)

 

(As Restated)

 

 

 

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

184,269

 

297,267

 

301,992

 

316,853

 

Gross profit

 

13,723

 

18,653

 

27,468

 

14,755

 

Operating expenses

 

18,946

 

24,089

 

21,283

 

24,356

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest, and cumulative effect

 

(7,554

)

7,993

 

4,985

 

11,571

 

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

(1,500

)

4,320

 

2,416

 

7,696

 

Minority interest income (expense)

 

557

 

257

 

49

 

4,193

 

Income (loss) before cumulative effect

 

(5,497

)

3,673

 

2,618

 

(15,074

)

Cumulative effect

 

240

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

(5,257

)

3,673

 

2,618

 

(15,074

)

Net income (loss) per common share before cumulative effect:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

(0.25

)

0.17

 

0.12

 

(0.69

)

Diluted

 

(0.25

)

0.17

 

0.12

 

(0.69

)

Net income (loss)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

(0.24

)

0.17

 

0.12

 

(0.69

)

Diluted

 

(0.24

)

0.17

 

0.12

 

(0.69

)

 

144



 

The following selected unaudited, quarterly financial data of the Company for all quarters in fiscal 2001 and the first three quarters of fiscal 2002 have been restated (see Note 2).

 

 

 

Fiscal 2001
For the Quarter Ended February 28,

 

 

 

As Reported (1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

328,302

 

$

19,745

(2)(5)

 

$

348,047

 

Cost of sales

 

301,212

 

18,387

(2)

$

4,587

(3)

324,186

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

27,090

 

1,358

 

(4,587

)

23,861

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

7,021

 

 

 

7,021

 

General and administrative

 

11,134

 

 

(144

)(3)

10,990

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

5,345

 

 

(4,443

)(3)

902

 

Total operating expenses

 

23,500

 

 

(4,587

)

18,913

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income

 

3,590

 

1,358

 

 

4,948

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

604

 

 

 

604

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income before provision for income taxes and minority interest

 

4,194

 

1,358

 

 

5,552

 

Provision for income taxes

 

1,458

 

571

(4)

 

2,029

 

Minority interest

 

(170

)

 

 

(170

)

Net income

 

$

2,566

 

$

787

 

 

$

3,353

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per common share (basic)

 

$

0.12

 

$

0.03

 

 

$

0.15

 

Net income per common share (diluted)

 

$

0.12

 

$

0.03

 

 

$

0.15

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,654,486

 

 

 

 

 

21,654,486

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

22,034,838

 

 

 

 

 

22,034,838

 

 

Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments.

 


(1)          Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively.

(2)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (a) revenue recognition.

(3)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(4)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(5)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

 

145



 

 

 

Fiscal 2001
For the Quarter Ended May 31,

 

 

 

As Reported(1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

276,814

 

$

(233

)(4)

 

$

276,581

 

Cost of sales

 

266,090

 

 

$

5,098

(2) 

271,188

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

10,724

 

(233

)

(5,098

)

5,393

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

7,372

 

 

 

7,372

 

General and administrative

 

10,577

 

190

 

(147

)(2)

10,620

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

5,956

 

 

(4,951

)(2)

1,005

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

 

23,905

 

190

 

(5,098

)

18,997

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

 

(13,181

)

(423

)

 

(13,604

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

(287

)

 

 

(287

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest

 

(13,468

)

423

(5)

 

(13,891

)

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

(4,649

)

(375

)(3)

 

(5,024

)

Minority interest

 

556

 

6

(5)

 

562

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

(8,263

)

$

(42

)

 

$

(8,305

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic)

 

$

(0.38

)

$

0.00

 

 

$

(0.38

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted)

 

$

(0.38

)

$

0.00

 

 

$

(0.38

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,920,990

 

 

 

 

 

21,920,990

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

21,920,990

 

 

 

 

 

21,920,990

 

 

Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments.

 


(1)          Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively.

(2)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(3)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(4)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

(5)          Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.

 

146



 

 

 

Fiscal  2001
For the Quarter Ended August 31,

 

 

 

As Reported (1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

311,715

 

$

(904

)(2)(5)

 

$

310,811

 

Cost of sales

 

282,745

 

(942

)(2)

$

5,007

(3)

286,810

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

28,970

 

38

 

(5,007

)

24,001

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

8,018

 

 

 

8,018

 

General and administrative

 

12,261

 

303

 

(149

)(3)

12,415

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

5,895

 

 

(4,858

)(3)

1,037

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

 

26,174

 

303

 

(5,007

)

21,470

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

 

2,796

 

(265

)

 

2,531

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

(1,283

)

 

 

(1,283

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest

 

1,513

 

(265

)

 

1,248

 

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

618

 

(78

)(4)

 

540

 

Minority interest

 

111

 

10

(6)

 

121

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

1,006

 

$

(177

)

 

$

829

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic)

 

$

0.05

 

$

(0.01

)

 

$

0.04

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted)

 

$

0.05

 

$

(0.01

)

 

$

0.04

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,966,461

 

 

 

 

 

21,966,461

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

22,170,039

 

 

 

 

 

22,170,039

 

 

Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments.

 


(1)          Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively.

(2)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue.

(3)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(4)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(5)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

 

147



 

(6)   Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.

 

 

 

Fiscal 2001
For the Quarter Ended November 30,

 

 

 

As Reported(1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

339,803

 

$

1,349

(2)(6) 

 

$

341,152

 

Cost of sales

 

317,160

 

524

(2)(5)

$

5,333

(3)

323,017

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

22,643

 

825

 

(5,333

)

18,135

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

7,628

 

 

 

7,628

 

General and administrative

 

12,433

 

196

(5)

(148

)(3)

12,481

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

6,322

 

 

(5,185

)(3)

1,137

 

Total operating expenses

 

26,383

 

196

 

(5,333

)

21,246

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

 

(3,740

)

629

 

 

(3,111

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

(1,282

)

 

 

(1,282

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest

 

(5,022

)

629

 

 

(4,393

)

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

(1,364

)

195

(4)

 

(1,169

)

Minority interest

 

140

 

7

(7)

 

147

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

(3,518

)

$

441

 

 

$

(3,077

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (basic)

 

$

(0.16

)

$

0.02

 

 

$

(0.14

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share (diluted)

 

$

(0.16

)

$

0.02

 

 

$

(0.14

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,966,461

 

 

 

 

 

21,966,461

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

21,966,461

 

 

 

 

 

21,966,461

 

 

Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments.

 


(1)          Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively.

(2)   Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue.

(3)   Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(4)   Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

 

148



 

(5)   Amounts reflect adjustments for (c) litigation.

(6)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

(7)   Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.

 

149



 

 

 

Fiscal 2002
For the Quarter Ended February 28,

 

 

 

As Reported (1)

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

188,597

 

$

(4,328

)(2)(8)

 

$

184,269

 

Cost of sales

 

170,781

 

(5,058

)(2)(6)(7)

$

4,823

(3)

170,546

 

Gross profit

 

17,816

 

730

 

(4,823

)

13,723

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

6,754

 

(3

)(2)

 

6,751

 

General and administrative

 

10,651

 

542

(2)(5)(6)

(140

)(3)

11,053

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

5,846

 

(21

)(2)

(4,683

)(3)

1,142

 

Total operating expenses

 

23,251

 

518

 

(4,823

)

18,946

 

Operating income (loss)

 

(5,435

)

212

 

 

(5,223

)

Total other income (expense), net

 

(981

)

(1,350

)(5)

 

(2,331

)

Loss before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest and before cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

(6,416

)

(1,138

)

 

(7,554

)

Provision for (recovery of) income taxes

 

(1,670

)

170

(4)

 

(1,500

)

Minority interest

 

557

 

 

 

557

 

Loss before cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

(4,189

)

(1,308

)

 

(5,497

)

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

240

 

 

 

240

 

Net loss

 

$

(3,949

)

$

(1,308

)

 

$

(5,257

)

Net loss per common share (basic) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

$

(0.19

)

$

(0.06

)

 

$

(0.25

)

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

0.01

 

 

 

0.01

 

Net loss per common share (basic)

 

$

(0.18

)

$

(0.06

)

 

$

(0.24

)

Net loss per common share (diluted) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

$

(0.19

)

$

(0.06

)

 

$

(0.25

)

Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill

 

0.01

 

 

 

0.01

 

Net loss per common share (diluted)

 

$

(0.18

)

$

(0.06

)

 

$

(0.24

)

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,967,263

 

 

 

 

 

21,967,263

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

21,967,263

 

 

 

 

 

21,967,263

 

 

Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments.

 


(1)          Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9.

(2)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue.

(3)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(4)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(5)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (d) foreign currency translation.

 

150



 

(6)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (c)litigation.

(7)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (e) inventory pricing.

(8)          Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

 

 

 

Fiscal 2002
For the Quarter Ended May 31,

 

 

 

As Reported

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

304,603

 

$

(7,336

)(1)(7)

 

$

297,267

 

Cost of sales

 

280,778

 

(7,537

)(1)(5)(6)

$

5,373

(2)

278,614

 

Gross profit

 

23,825

 

201

 

(5,373

)

18,653

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

7,631

 

(10

)(1)

 

7,621

 

General and administrative

 

15,856

 

245

(1)(4)

(148

)(2)

15,953

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

5,889

 

(149

)(1)(4)

(5,225

)(2)

515

 

Total operating expenses

 

29,376

 

86

 

(5,373

)

24,089

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

 

(5,551

)

115

 

 

(5,436

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

14,843

 

(1,627

)(4)(9)

 

13,216

 

Income before provision for income taxes and minority interest

 

9,292

 

(1,512

)

 

7,780

 

Provision for income taxes

 

5,092

 

(772

)(3)

 

4,320

 

Minority interest

 

255

 

(42

)(8)

 

 

213

 

Net income

 

$

4,455

 

$

(782

)

 

$

3,673

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per common share (basic)

 

$

0.20

 

$

(0.03

)

 

$

0.17

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per common share (diluted)

 

$

0.20

 

$

(0.03

)

 

$

0.17

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,967,263

 

 

 

 

 

21,967,263

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

22,007,598

 

 

 

 

 

22,007,598

 

 

Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments.

 


(1) Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue.

(2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

(3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (d) foreign currency translation.

(5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (c)litigation.

(6) Amounts reflect adjustments for (e) inventory pricing.

 

151



 

(7) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

(8)  Amounts reflect adjustments for gain on issuance of subsidiary shares.

(9) Amounts reflect impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest

 

 

 

Fiscal 2002
For the Quarter Ended August 31,

 

 

 

As Reported

 

Restatement
Adjustments

 

Reclassification
Adjustments

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

291,367

 

$

10,625

(1)(7)

 

$

301,992

 

Cost of sales

 

259,791

 

9,441

(1)(5)(6)

$

5,292

(2) 

274,524

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

31,576

 

1,184

 

(5,292

)

27,468

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling

 

7,486

 

11

(1)

 

7,497

 

General and administrative

 

13,208

 

(372

)(1)(4)(5)

(150

)(2)

12,686

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

6,138

 

104

(1)(4)

(5,142

)(2)

1,100

 

Total operating expenses

 

26,832

 

(257

)

(5,292

)

21,283

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

 

4,744

 

1,441

 

 

6,185

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

(953

)

(247

)(4)

 

(1,200

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income before provision for income taxes and minority interest

 

3,791

 

1,194

 

 

4,985

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for income taxes

 

2,018

 

398

(3)

 

2,416

 

Minority interest

 

94

 

(45

)(8)

 

49

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

$

1,867

 

$

751

 

 

$

2,618

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per common share (basic)

 

$

0.09

 

$

0.03

 

 

$

0.12

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per common share (diluted)

 

$

0.08

 

$

0.04

 

 

$

0.12

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,947,573

 

 

 

 

 

21,947,573

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

21,982,803

 

 

 

 

 

21,982,803

 

 

Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments.

 


(1) Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue.

(2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification.

 

152



 

(3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes.

(4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (d) foreign currency translation.

(5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (c)litigation.

(6) Amounts reflect adjustments for (e) inventory pricing.

(7) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives.

(8) Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest.

 

 

 

Fiscal 2002
For the Quarter Ended
November 30,

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

$

316,853

 

Cost of sales

 

302,098

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

14,755

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

 

 

 

Selling

 

7,639

 

General and administrative

 

15,600

 

Warehousing and technical support

 

1,117

 

Total operating expenses

 

24,356

 

 

 

 

 

Operating loss

 

(9,601

)

 

 

 

 

Total other income (expense), net

 

(1,970

)

 

 

 

 

Loss before provision for income taxes and minority interest

 

(11,571

)

 

 

 

 

Provision for income taxes

 

7,696

 

Minority interest

 

4,193

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

$

(15,074

)

 

 

 

 

Net loss per common share (basic)

 

$

(0.69

)

 

 

 

 

Net loss per common share (diluted)

 

$

(0.69

)

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic)

 

21,809,903

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted)

 

21,809,903

 

 

(27)                            Fourth Quarter Adjustments

 

During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company recorded the following adjustments to its statement of operations (i) a $13,090 valuation allowance for deferred tax assets that were considered more likely than not to be unrecoverable related to the Wireless segment (note 16); (ii) an inventory

 

153



 

obsolescence charge of $7,665  and $2,725 for the Wireless Group and Electronics Group, respectively, relating to inventory (Note 1(f)); (iii) a $1,158 other-than-temporary impairment charge related to investment securities (Note 9); (iv) a $2,091 bad debt reserve related to certain customers whose financial condition and ability to pay their outstanding receivables became doubtful during the fourth quarter;  and (v) the reversal of unearned sales incentives of $763 and $947 for the Wireless Group and Electronics Group, respectively.  The Company has determined that none of these adjustments relate to prior quarters.

 

154



 

(28)                            Accrued Sales Incentives

 

During the quarter ended May 31, 2002, the Company adopted the provisions of EITF 01-9.  As a result of adopting EITF 01-9 in 2002, the Company has reclassified co-operative advertising, market development funds and volume incentive rebate costs (collectively sales incentives), which were previously included in selling expenses, to net sales as the Company does not receive an identifiable benefit in connection with these costs.  As a result of this reclassification, net sales and selling expenses, after restatement, were reduced by $15,388 and $11,100 for the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, respectively.  There was no further impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements as a result of the adoption of EITF 01-9 as the Company’s historical accounting policy with respect to the recognition and measure of sales incentives is consistent with EITF 01-9.

 

A summary of the activity with respect to sales incentives for the last three years on a segment and consolidated basis is provided below:

 

Wireless

 

 

 

Fiscal
2000

 

Fiscal
2001

 

Fiscal
2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Opening balance

 

$

7,771

 

$

11,700

 

$

5,209

 

Accruals

 

21,240

 

19,680

 

31,186

 

Payments

 

(9,046

)

(13,616

)

(25,654

)

Reversals for unearned incentives

 

(3,197

)

(7,535

)

(570

)

Reversals for unclaimed incentives

 

(5,068

)

(5,020

)

(2,646

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending balance

 

$

11,700

 

$

5,209

 

$

7,525

 

 

Electronics

 

 

 

Fiscal
2000

 

Fiscal
2001

 

Fiscal
2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Opening balance

 

$

3,366

 

$

2,894

 

$

3,265

 

Accruals

 

3,496

 

5,789

 

7,665

 

Payments

 

(2,885

)

(3,604

)

(4,804

)

Reversals for unearned incentives

 

(970

)

(1,516

)

(784

)

Reversals for unclaimed incentives

 

(113

)

(298

)

(716

)

Ending balance

 

$

2,894

 

$

3,265

 

$

4,626

 

 

155



 

 

Consolidated

 

 

 

Fiscal
2000

 

Fiscal
2001

 

Fiscal
2002

 

 

 

As Restated

 

As Restated

 

 

 

Opening balance

 

$

11,137

 

$

14,594

 

$

8,474

 

Accruals

 

24,736

 

25,469

 

38,851

 

Payments

 

(11,931

)

(17,220

)

(30,458

)

Reversals

 

(9,348

)

(14,369

)

(4,716

)

Ending balance

 

$

14,594

 

$

8,474

 

$

12,151

 

 

The majority of the reversals of previously established sales incentive liabilities pertain to sales recorded in prior periods.

 

(29)         Subsequent Events

 

In May 2003, the Company entered into an asset purchase agreement to buy certain assets of Recoton Corporation.  In accordance with the agreement, the Company made a deposit of $2,000, which is currently being held in escrow.  The Company is awaiting final approval of this purchase from a bankruptcy court.  This purchase would amount to approximately $40,000 plus the assumption of $5,000 in debt, not including related acquisition costs.

 

156



 

Item 9 - Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

 

None

 

PART III

 

Item 10 - Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant

 

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance

 

See the information set forth in the section entitled “Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant” in Part I, Item 4(d) of this Form 10-K.

 

Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act requires our executive officers, directors and persons who own more than ten percent of a registered class of our equity securities (“Reporting Persons”) to file reports of ownership and changes in ownership on Forms 3, 4 and 5 with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and the Nasdaq Stock Market (the “Nasdaq”).  These Reporting Persons are required by SEC regulation to furnish us with copies of all Form 3, 4 and 5 they file with the SEC and Nasdaq.  Based solely upon our review of the copies of the forms it has received, we believe that all Reporting Persons complied on a timely basis with all filing requirements applicable to them with respect to transactions during fiscal 2002.

 

Item 11 - Executive Compensation

 

The following Summary Compensation Table sets forth the compensation earned by each individual who served as the Company’s Chief Executive Officer during fiscal year 2002 and the four other most highly compensated executive officers who were serving as such as of November 30,2002 (collectively, the “Named Officers”).

 

Summary Compensation Table

 

 

 

Annual Compensation (1)

 

 

 

Name and Principal Position

 

Year

 

Salary(2)

 

Bonus

 

All Other
Compensation(3)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

John J. Shalam

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

President and CEO

 

2002

 

450,677

 

128,669

 

11,025

 

 

 

2001

 

450,000

 

122,000

 

9,185

 

 

 

2000

 

450,000

 

1,273,000

 

16,616

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Philip Christopher

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Executive Vice President

 

2002

 

476,419

(4)

1,800,000

 

2,762

 

 

 

2001

 

450,000

 

117,000

 

8,234

 

 

 

2000

 

450,000

 

897,000

 

8,721

 

 

157



 

 

 

Annual Compensation (1)

 

 

 

Name and Principal Position

 

Year

 

Salary(2)

 

Bonus

 

All Other
Compensation(3)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Charles M. Stoehr

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior Vice President and

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CFO

 

2002

 

326,418

 

242,890

 

4,253

 

 

 

2001

 

325,000

 

41,000

 

8,234

 

 

 

2000

 

325,000

 

449,000

 

10,902

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Patrick M. Lavelle

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Senior Vice President

 

2002

 

201,277

 

1,204,508

 

1,980

 

 

 

2001

 

200,000

 

655,636

 

7,998

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2000

 

200,000

 

781,365

 

8,709

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Richard A. Maddia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vice President,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Information Systems

 

2002

 

176,209

 

37,500

 

1,213

 

 

 

2001

 

175,000

 

65,000

 

7,409

 

 

 

2000

 

150,500

 

52,500

 

8,313

 

 


(1)           No other annual compensation was paid and no restricted stock awards or options were granted to the named individuals in 2002, 2001 and 2000 and the “Other Annual Compensation”, “Restricted Stock” and “Securities Underlying Options” columns have been omitted.

(2)           For fiscal 2002, salary includes: for Mr. Shalam $677 in 401(k) Company matching contributions; for Mr. Christopher $1,419 in 401(k) Company matching contributions; for Mr. Lavelle $1,277 in 401(k) Company matching contributions; and for Mr. Maddia $709 in 401(k) Company matching contributions.

(3)           For fiscal 2002, this only includes executive life insurance premiums paid for the benefit of the named executive.

(4)           Mr. Christopher’s base salary for the first six (6) months of fiscal 2002 was $450,000.  Effective May 29, 2002, Mr. Christopher’s base salary was increased to $500,000 pursuant to an employment agreement (see discussion below under caption “Employment Agreements”).

 

Employment Agreements

 

Effective May 29, 2002, Audiovox Communications Corporation (“ACC”) entered into an employment agreement with Philip Christopher (the “Agreement”).  The Agreement, unless terminated earlier, shall continue until May 29, 2007 and thereafter shall automatically extend by consecutive twelve-month periods unless terminated by ACC on written notice.

 

Pursuant to the Agreement, Mr. Christopher receives a base salary of $500,000, subject to annual Consumer Price Index increases, and an annual bonus equal to two (2%) percent of ACC’s annual earnings before income taxes.

 

158



 

The Agreement further provides for equity incentives, vesting of stock options, reimbursement of reasonable business expenses and use of an automobile.  The Agreement also provided for a bonus pool of $3.2 million, of which Mr. Christopher received $1.8 million (See Bonus disclosure in the Executive Compensation Table).

 

In the event ACC terminates Mr. Christopher’s employment without cause or if Mr. Christopher resigns his employment within ninety (90) days after: a significant adverse change in his authority and responsibilities; a reduction in his base salary; nonpayment of his bonus; or a material breach by ACC of any obligation under this Agreement, Mr. Christopher is entitled to receive a separation payment equal to his salary for the remainder of the contract term, plus an average annual bonus plus a cash payment of one million dollars.  Mr. Christopher will not be entitled to a separation payment if his employment with ACC is terminated for any reason after the fifth anniversary of the effective date.

 

The Agreement also contains non-competition and non-solicitation covenants that are effective for one year following termination of employment for any reason.

 

Option Grants in Last Fiscal Year (2002)

 

No options were granted in the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002.

 

Aggregate Option Exercises in Last Fiscal Year

and Fiscal Year-End Option Values

 

The following table sets forth information concerning option exercises in fiscal year 2002 and option holdings as of November 30, 2002 with respect to each of the Named Officers.  No stock appreciation rights were outstanding at the end of that year.

 

 

 

Shares
Acquired
on Exercise

 

Value
Realized($)

 

Number of Securities
Underlying
Options at
November 30, 2002

 

Value* of
In-the-money
Options at
November 30,
2002

 

Name

 

 

 

Exercisable/
Unexercisable

 

Exercisable/
Unexercisable

 

John J. Shalam

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

525,000/0

 

$

1,945,125/$0

 

Philip Christopher

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

1,011,000/0

 

$

1,158,538/$0

 

Charles M. Stoehr

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

172,500/0

 

$

193,538/$0

 

Patrick M. Lavelle

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

245,700/0

 

$

217,253/$0

 

Richard A. Maddia

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

40,000/0

 

$

62,050/$0

 

 


*      Based on the fair market value of the Company’s Common Stock at November 30, 2002 less the exercise price payable for such shares.

 

159



 

Long-Term Incentive Plans - Awards in Last Fiscal Year

 

Name

 

Number of Shares,
Units of Other Rights(1)

 

Performance or Other Period
Until Maturation or Payout

 

 

 

 

 

John J. Shalam

 

7.1428571364 Units(2)

 

An initial public offering by Audiovox Communications Corp. (“ACC”) or an acquisition of a controlling interest in ACC

Philip Christopher

 

7.1428571364 Units(2)

 

An initial public offering by ACC - or the plan termination date, May 28, 2007.

Charles M. Stoehr

 

N/A

 

N/A

Patrick M. Lavelle

 

N/A

 

N/A

Richard A. Maddia

 

N/A

 

N/A

 


(1)                                  The awards relate to the Class A Common Stock of Audiovox Communications Corp., (the “Stock”) a subsidiary of Audiovox Corporation, which has 146.666666 shares issued and outstanding.  Audiovox Corporation owns 75% of those shares.  Each unit is equivalent to one share of stock.

(2)                                  The value of these appreciation units shall be equivalent to the value of one outstanding share of stock at such time that the performance criteria is achieved.

 

Compensation of Directors

 

For their service, members of the Board of Directors who are not our salaried employees receive an annual retainer of $15,000 and $500 for each meeting attended.

 

Compensation Committee Report on Executive Compensation

 

Responsibilities of the Committee

 

The Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors reviews and approves compensation for Audiovox’s executive officers and oversees and administers Audiovox’s stock option and restricted stock plans. The Compensation Committee recommends compensation for the Chief Executive Officer subject to the Board of Directors approval of such recommendations. The Chief Executive Officer submits recommended compensation levels for other executive officers of Audiovox to the Compensation Committee for its review and approval, subject to applicable employment agreements. Each member of the Compensation Committee is a non-employee Director of Audiovox. The Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors has furnished the following report on executive compensation for fiscal 2002.

 

What is Audiovox’s Philosophy of Executive Officer Compensation?

 

Our compensation programs are designed to attract and retain talented executives and motivate them to achieve corporate and business objectives that will increase stockholder value. To attain both near

 

160



 

and long term corporate goals, it is our policy to provide incentives to senior management and reward outstanding performance and contributions to Audiovox’s businesses. Consequently, Audiovox’s compensation program for its executives includes a competitive base salary, a performance-based annual bonus and stock-based compensation.  This approach to executive compensation enables Audiovox to attract and retain executives of outstanding ability while ensuring that our executives’ compensation advances the interests of our shareholders. Consequently, a large proportion of our executives’ compensation, the annual bonus, is dependent in significant part on Audiovox’s performance. Although Audiovox does not have employment agreements with any of its executive officers, Mr. Philip Christopher’s compensation is governed by an employment agreement with Audiovox Communications Corp.

 

Base Salary

 

Salaries for the executive officers are designed to attract and retain qualified and dedicated executive officers.  Annually, the Committee reviews salary recommendations made by Audiovox’s Chief Executive Officer and evaluates individual responsibility levels, experience, performance and length of service. Base salaries for Audiovox’s executive officers are fixed at levels commensurate with competitive amounts paid to senior executives with comparable qualifications at companies engaged in the same or similar businesses.

 

Annual Bonus

 

Bonus compensation provides Audiovox with a means of rewarding performance based upon attainment of corporate profitable during the fiscal year. For fiscal 2002, the Compensation Committee established bonus compensation formulas for its executives based upon the pre-tax earnings of the Company. The annual bonus paid to Mr. Lavelle is based upon the achievement of fiscal goals within Audiovox Electronics Corp. Mr. Christopher’s annual bonus for fiscal 2002 was paid pursuant to his employment agreement.

 

Stock Options

 

During fiscal 2002, no stock options were granted to the Company’s employees, including the Company’s executive officers.

 

How is the Chief Executive Officer Compensated?

 

The Compensation Committee has fixed the base salary of the Chief Executive Officer based on competitive compensation data, the Committee’s assessment of Mr. Shalam’s past performance and its expectation as to his future contributions in guiding and directing Audiovox and its business. Mr. Shalam’s 8 bonus for fiscal 2002 was calculated on Audiovox’s pre-income tax profit before extraordinary items, other non-recurring transactions and income taxes of the Company in accordance with Audiovox’s Executive Officer Bonus Plan that was approved by the shareholders in 2000.

 

How is Audiovox Addressing Internal Revenue Code Limits on Deductibility of Compensation?

 

Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code generally disallows a tax deduction to public

 

161



 

corporations for compensation over $1,000,000 paid for any fiscal year to the corporation’s chief executive officer and four other most highly compensated executive officers as of the end of any fiscal year.  However, the statute exempts qualifying performance-based compensation from the deduction limit if certain requirements are met. The Compensation Committee currently intends to structure performance-based compensation, including stock option grants and annual bonuses, to executive officers who may be subject to Section 162(m) in a manner that satisfies those requirements.  The Board and the Compensation Committee reserve the authority to award non-deductible compensation in other circumstances as they deem appropriate. Further, because of ambiguities and uncertainties as to the application and interpretation of Section 162(m) and the regulations issued thereunder, no assurance can be given, notwithstanding the Company’s efforts, that compensation intended by the Company to satisfy the requirements for deductibility under Section 162(m) does in fact do so.

 

Members of the Compensation Committee

 

 

PAUL C. KREUCH, JR.

DENNIS F. MCMANUS

IRVING HALEVY

 

 

Performance Graph

 

COMPARISON OF CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN

OF COMPANY, INDUSTRY INDEX AND BROAD MARKET

 

COMPARE 5-YEAR CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN

AMONG AUDIOVOX CORPORATION,

NASDAQ MARKET INDEX AND SIC CODE INDEX

[GRAPH OMITTED]

 

 

 

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION

100.00

73.05

337.59

109.20

81.82

122.44

SIC CODE INDEX

100.00

75.93

84.07

64.27

64.72

55.98

NASDAQ MARKET INDEX

100.00

123.61

202.45

168.13

125.82

98.47

 

 

 

The annual changes for the five year period are based on the assumption that $100 had been invested on December 1, 1997, and that all quarterly dividends were reinvested. The total cumulative dollar returns shown on the graph represent the value that such investments would have had on November 30, 2002.

 

 

 

 

 

162



 

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

 

The Compensation Committee is currently comprised of two independent directors, Paul C. Kreuch, Jr. and Dennis McManus.

 

Item 12 - Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management

 

The following table sets forth, as of May 30, 2003, certain information with respect to shares beneficially owned by (i) each person who is known by the Company to be the beneficial owner of more than five percent (5%) of the Company’s outstanding shares of Common Stock, (ii) each of the Company’s directors and the executive officers named in the Summary Compensation Table below and (iii) all current directors and executive officers as a group.

 

Beneficial ownership has been determined in accordance with Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act.  Under this rule, certain shares may be deemed to be beneficially owned by more than one person (if, for example, persons share the power to vote or the power to dispose of the shares).  In addition, shares are deemed to be beneficially owned by a person if the person has the right to acquire shares (for example, upon exercise of an option or warrant) within sixty (60) days of the date as of which the information is provided.  In computing the percentage ownership of any person, the number of shares is deemed to include the number of shares beneficially owned by such person (and only such person) by reason of such acquisition rights.  As a result, the percentage of outstanding shares of any person as shown in the following table does not necessarily reflect the person’s actual voting power at any particular date. 

 

Name and Address (1)

 

Sole Voting or
Investment
Power

 

Percent of
Outstanding
Shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

John J. Shalam

 

4,590,577

(3)

21.7

%

Philip Christopher

 

983,474

 

4.6

%

Patrick M. Lavelle

 

183,078

 

*

 

Charles M. Stoehr

 

144,549

 

*

 

Richard Maddia

 

37,040

 

*

 

Ann M. Boutcher

 

16,323

 

*

 

Paul C. Kreuch, Jr.

 

13,000

 

*

 

Dennis F. McManus

 

11,000

 

*

 

Irving Halevy

 

 

*

 

Peter Lesser

 

 

*

 

All directors and officers as a group (10 persons)

 

5,979,041

 

26.8

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

Name and Address of Other 5% Holders of Common Stock

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dimensional Fund Advisors, Inc. (4)
1299 Ocean Ave, 11th Floor
Santa Monica, CA 90401

 

1,245,721

 

6.0

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

Kahn Brothers & Co., Inc. (5)
1299 Ocean Ave, 11th Floor
Santa Monica, CA 90401

 

1,340,265

 

6.5

%

 

163



 


*                                         Represents less than 1%

 

(1)                                  The address of each person, unless otherwise noted, is c/o Audiovox Corporation, 150 Marcus Blvd., Hauppauge, NY  11788.  In presents shares beneficially owned and in calculating each holder’s percentage ownership, only options exercisable by that person within 60 days of February 1, 2003 and no options exercisable by any other person are deemed to be outstanding.

 

(2)                                  The number of shares stated as “beneficially owned” includes stock options currently exercisable as follows: Mr. Shalam – 525,000, Mr. Christopher – 779,000, Mr. Lavelle – 165,700, Mr. Stoehr – 132,500, Mr. Maddia – 32,000, Ms. Boutcher – 11,000, Mr. Kreuch – 11,000 and Mr. McManus – 11,000.

 

(3)                                  Includes 2,144,152 shares of Class B common stock held by Mr. Shalam that he may convert into Class A common stock at any time.  Excludes 116,802 shares of Class B common stock and 2,002 shares of Class A common stock that are held in irrevocable trusts for the benefit of Mr. Shalam’s three sons.

 

(4)                                  Information reported is derived from a Schedule 13G dated February 3, 2003 of Dimensional Fund Advisors Inc. and filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 11, 2003.

 

(5)                                  Information reported is derived from a Schedule 13G of Kahn Brothers & Co., Inc. filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 6, 2003.

 

Item 13 - Certain Relationships and Related Transactions

 

Transactions With Management

 

We lease some of our equipment, office, warehouse and distribution facilities from entities in which our executive officers own controlling interests.  The following table identifies leases that result in payments in excess of $60,000 to any of the related entities.

 

Real Property
Location

 

Expiration Date

 

Owner of Property

 

Rent Paid
During
Fiscal
Year
2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

150 Marcus Blvd.  Hauppauge, NY

 

November 30, 2008

 

150 Marcus Blvd. Realty LLC (1)

 

$

530,000

 

 

164



 

Real Property
Location

 

Expiration Date

 

Owner of Property

 

Rent Paid
During 
Fiscal 
Year
2002

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

16808 Marquardt Avenue Cerritos, CA

 

June 30, 2008

 

Marquardt Associates (2)

 

563,399

 

555 Wireless Blvd.  Hauppauge, NY

 

December 1, 2026

 

Wireless Blvd. Realty, LLC (3)

 

589,340

 

110 Marcus Blvd.  Hauppauge, NY

 

May 31, 2006

 

110 Marcus Blvd. Realty LLC (4)

 

113,220

 

 

Equipment
Location

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

555 Wireless Blvd.  Hauppauge, NY

 

March 31, 2003

 

Wireless Blvd. Realty, LLC (3)

 

410,640

 

 


(1)                                  Property owned by 150 Marcus Blvd. Realty LLC, a New York limited liability company, of which John J. Shalam owns 1% and Mr. Shalam’s three sons own the remaining 99%.

 

(2)                                  Property owned by Marquardt Associates, a California partnership, owned 60% by John J. Shalam and 40% by Ardama Capital LLC, a New York limited liability company owned by Mr. Shalam’s three sons.

 

(3)                                  Property owned or leased by Wireless Blvd. Realty, LLC, a New York limited liability company, owned 98% by the Shalam Long Term Trust, 1% by John J. Shalam and 1% by Mr. Shalam’s three sons.  The Shalam Long Term Trust is a grantor trust of which Mr. Shalam is the Grantor and his three sons are the beneficiaries.

 

(4)                                  Property owned or leased by 110 Marcus Blvd. Realty, LLC, a Ne York limited liability company, of which John J. Shalam owns 1% and Mr. Shalam’s sons own the remaining 99%.

 

We believe that the terms of each of the leases are no less favorable to us than those that could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties.  To the extent that conflicts of interest arise between us and such persons in the future, such conflicts will be resolved by a committee of disinterested directors.

 

PART IV

 

Item 14 - Controls and Procedures

 

Within the 90-day period immediately preceding the filing of this Report, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer has each evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s “Disclosure

 

165



 

Controls and Procedures” and has concluded that they were effective.  As such term is used above, the Company’s Controls and Procedures are controls and other procedures of the Company that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports that it files or submits under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the Security Exchange Commission’s rules and forms.  Disclosure Controls and Procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Company in such reports is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management, including its principal executive officer or officers and principal financial officer or officers, or persons performing similar functions, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

 

There were no significant changes in the Company’s internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect such controls subsequent to the date that the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer conducted their evaluations of the Disclosure Controls and Procedures, including any corrective actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material weaknesses.

 

PART IV

 

Item 15 - Exhibits, Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules and Reports on Form 8-K

 

(a) (1)

 

The following are included in Item 8 of this Report:

 

Independent Auditors’ Report

 

Consolidated Balance Sheets of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries as of November 30, 2001 and 2002.

 

Consolidated Statements of Operations of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries for the Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002.

 

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity and Comprehensive Income (Loss)  of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries for the Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002.

 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries for the Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002.

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

(a) (2)

Financial Statement Schedules of the Registrant for the Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002.

 

Independent Auditors’ Report on Financial Statement Schedules (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2002).

 

166



 

Schedule II- Valuation and Qualifying Accounts (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2002).

 

All other financial statement schedules not listed are omitted because they are either not required or the information is otherwise included.

 

167



 

(3)                                  Exhibits

 

See Item 15(c) for Index of Exhibits.

 

(b)                                 Reports on Form 8-K

 

During the fourth quarter, the Company filed one report on Form 8-K, dated October 21, 2002 and filed on October 22, 2002.  The Form 8-K reported that on October 21, 2002, Audiovox Corporation submitted to the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) the Statements under Oath of the Principal Executive Officer and the Principal Financial Officer in accordance with the SEC’s June 27, 2002 Order requiring the filing of sworn statements pursuant to Section 21(a)(1) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

 

(c)                                  Exhibits

 

Exhibit 
Number

 

Description

 

 

 

3.1

 

Certificate of Incorporation of the Company (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-1; No. 33-107, filed May 4, 1987).

 

 

 

3.1a

 

Amendment to Certificate of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 1993).

 

 

 

3.1b

 

Amendment to Certificate of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2000).

 

 

 

3.2

 

By-laws of the Company (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-1; No. 33-10726, filed May 4, 1987).

 

 

 

10.1

 

The Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among the Registrant and the several banks and financial institutions dated as of July 28, 1999 (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on October 27, 1999).

 

 

 

10.2

 

First Amendment, dated as of October 13, 1999, to the Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among the Registrant and the several banks and financial institutions (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on October 27, 1999).

 

 

 

10.3

 

Second Amendment, dated as of December 20, 1999, to the Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among the Registrant and the several banks and financial institutions (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on January 13, 2000).

 

168



 

Exhibit 
Number

 

Description

 

 

 

10.4

 

Securities Purchase Agreement made and entered into as of May 29, 2002, by and among Toshiba Corporation, Audiovox Communications Corp. and Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.5

 

Stockholders Agreement made and entered into as of May 29, 2002, by and among Toshiba Corporation, Audiovox Communications Corp. and Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.6

 

Distribution Agreement made and entered into as of May 29, 2002, by and between Toshiba Corporation and Audiovox Communications Corp.(incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.7

 

Non-Negotiable Subordinated Convertible Promissory Note dated May 31, 2002 by Audiovox Communications Corp. in favor of Toshiba Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.8

 

Employment Agreement effective as of May 29, 2002 by and among Audiovox Communications Corp., Philip Christopher and Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.9

 

Trademark License Agreement made as of May 29, 2002 between Audiovox Corporation and Audiovox Communications Corp.(incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.10

 

Non-Negotiable Demand Note dated May 29, 2002 by Audiovox Communications Corp. in favor of Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.11

 

Sixth Amendment and Consent, dated as of May 28, 2002 to the Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of July 28, 1999 (as amended) among Audiovox Corporation, the several banks and other financial institutions from time to time parties thereto (collectively the “Lenders”) and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as administrative and collateral agent for the Lenders (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002).

 

 

 

10.12

 

Long Term Incentive Compensation Award to John J.  Shalam (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2002).

 

 

 

10.13

 

Long Term Incentive Compensation Award to Philip Christopher (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2002).

 

169



 

Exhibit 
Number

 

Description

 

 

 

21

 

Subsidiaries of the Registrant  (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2002).

 

 

 

23

 

Independent Auditors’ Consent  (incorporated by reference to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2002).

 

 

 

31.1

 

Certification Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) of The Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (filed herewith)

 

 

 

31.2

 

Certification Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) of The Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (filed herewith)

 

 

 

32.1

 

Certification Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) And Rule 15d-14(a) Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United State Code, As Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (filed herewith).

 

 

 

32.2

 

Certification Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) And Rule 15d-14(a) Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United State Code, As Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (filed herewith).

 

 

 

99.1

 

Consolidated Financial Report of Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC (ASA) as of November 30, 2002 and 2001 and for the Years Ended November 30, 2002, 2001 and 2000 (filed herewith).

 

 

 

99.2

 

Consent of McGladrey & Pullen, LLP (filed herewith).

 

(d)                                 All other schedules are omitted because the required information is shown in the financial statements or notes thereto or because they are not applicable.

 

170



 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

 

AUDIOVOX CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

October 7, 2004

BY:

/s/ John J. Shalam

 

 

John J. Shalam, President

 

     and Chief Executive Officer

 

171



 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature

 

Title

 

Date

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ John J. Shalam

 

President;
Chief Executive Officer

 

October 7, 2004

John J. Shalam

 

(Principal Executive Officer)

 

 

 

 

and Director

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Philip Christopher

 

Executive Vice President
and Director

 

October 7, 2004

Philip Christopher

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Charles M. Stoehr

 

Senior Vice President, 
Chief Financial Officer (Principal
Financial and Accounting Officer)

 

 

Charles M. Stoehr

 

and Director

 

October 7, 2004

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Patrick M. Lavelle

 

Director

 

October 7, 2004

Patrick M. Lavelle

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Ann Boutcher

 

Director

 

October 7, 2004

Ann Boutcher

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Richard A. Maddia

 

Director

 

October 7, 2004

Richard A. Maddia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Paul C. Kreuch, Jr.

 

Director

 

October 7, 2004

Paul C. Kreuch, Jr.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Dennis McManus

 

Director

 

October 7, 2004

Dennis McManus

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Irving Halevy

 

Director

 

October 7, 2004

Irving Halevy

 

 

 

 

 

172


Exhibit 31.1

 

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO RULE 13a-14(a) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

I, John J. Shalam, certify that:

 

1.             I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K/A of Audiovox Corporation;

 

2.             Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this annual report;

 

3.             Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this annual report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this annual report;

 

4.             The registrant’s other certifying officers and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-14 and 15d-14) for the registrant and have:

 

a)             Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

b)            Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

c)             Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5.             The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and to the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent function):

 

a)             All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

b)            Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

 

Date:

October 7, 2004

 

By:

/s/ John J. Shalam

 

 

 

John J. Shalam

 

 

Chief Executive Officer

 


Exhibit 31.2

 

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO RULE 13a-14(a) OF THE

SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

I, Charles M. Stoehr, certify that:

 

1.             I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K/A of Audiovox Corporation;

 

2.             Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3.             Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in the report;

 

4.             The registrant’s other certifying officers(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) for the registrant and have:

 

a)                                      Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

b)                                     Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

c)                                      Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5.             The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and to the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent function):

 

a)                                      All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

b)                                     Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

 

Date:

October 7, 2004

By:

/s/ Charles M. Stoehr

 

 

 

 

Charles M. Stoehr

 

 

 

Chief Financial Officer

 


Exhibit 32.1

 

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO RULE 13a-14(a) AND RULE 15d-14(a)

SECTION 1350, CHAPTER 63 OF TITLE 18 OF THE UNITED STATE CODE,

AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE

SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

 

 

In connection with the Annual Report on Form 10-K/A for the year ended November 30, 2002 (the “Report”) of Audiovox Corporation (the “Company”), as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof, I, John J. Shalam, the Chief Executive Officer of the Company certify, to the best of my knowledge, that:

 

(1)   The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and

 

(2)   The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

 

 

/s/ John J. Shalam

 

John J. Shalam

President and Chief Executive Officer

October 7, 2004

 


Exhibit 32.2

 

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO RULE 13a-14(a) AND RULE 15d-14(a)

SECTION 1350, CHAPTER 63 OF TITLE 18 OF THE UNITED STATE CODE,

AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE

SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

 

 

In connection with the Annual Report on Form 10-K/A for the year ended November 30, 2002, (the “Report”) of Audiovox Corporation (the “Company”), as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof, I, Charles M. Stoehr, the Chief Financial Officer of the Company certify, to the best of my knowledge, that:

 

(1)   The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and

 

(2)   The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

 

 

/s/ Charles M. Stoehr

 

Charles M. Stoehr

Chief Financial Officer

October 7, 2004

 


Exhibit 99.1

 

Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC

And Subsidiary

 

Consolidated Financial Report

11.30.02

 

 



 

 

Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

1

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated balance sheets

 

2

 

Consolidated statements of income

 

3

 

Consolidated statements of members’ equity

 

4

 

Consolidated statements of cash flows

 

5

 

Notes to financial statements

 

6-13

 

 



 

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

 

To the Members

Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC and Subsidiary

Elkhart, Indiana

 

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC and Subsidiary as of November 30, 2002 and 2001, and the related consolidated statements of income, members’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended November 30, 2002.  These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.  We believe that our audits provided a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC and Subsidiary as of November 30, 2002 and 2001, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended November 30, 2002, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

 

 

 

/s/ McGLADREY & PULLEN, LLP

 

 

Elkhart, Indiana

December 26, 2002

 

1



 

 

Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC and Subsidiary

 

Consolidated Balance Sheets

November 30, 2002 and 2001

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

Current Assets

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

$

2,954,573

 

$

1,463,009

 

Available-for-sale securities

 

 

965,000

 

Trade receivables

 

5,358,962

 

4,889,620

 

Note receivable

 

1,000,000

 

 

Inventories

 

11,090,071

 

10,756,837

 

Prepaid expenses

 

129,870

 

150,357

 

Total current assets

 

20,533,476

 

18,224,823

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Leasehold Improvements and Equipment, at depreciated cost

 

2,032,175

 

2,395,028

 

Intangibles

 

$

300,000

 

 

 

 

22,865,651

 

$

20,619,851

 

LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

Current Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

$

1,232,795

 

$

1,030,338

 

Accrued expenses:

 

 

 

 

 

Payroll and related taxes

 

516,396

 

498,733

 

Warranty

 

1,605,114

 

1,098,165

 

Other

 

93,334

 

166,819

 

Total current liabilities

 

3,447,639

 

2,794,055

 

Commitments and Contingencies

 

 

 

 

 

Members’ Equity

 

19,418,012

 

17,825,796

 

 

 

$

22,865,651

 

$

20,619,851

 

 

See Notes to Financial Statements.

 

2



 

 

Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC and Subsidiary

 

Consolidated Statements Of Income

Years Ended November 2002, 2001, and 2000

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

2000

 

Net sales

 

$

47,307,819

 

$

64,639,779

 

$

56,326,563

 

Cost of goods sold

 

38,648,272

 

51,434,778

 

46,660,770

 

Gross profit

 

8,659,547

 

13,205,001

 

9,665,793

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses:

 

5,303,729

 

6,320,205

 

5,597,203

 

Operating income

 

3,355,818

 

6,884,796

 

4,068,590

 

Non-operating income (expense):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest income

 

130,370

 

82,058

 

36,390

 

Interest expense

 

(288

)

(58,431

)

(94,388

)

 

 

130,082

 

23,627

 

(57,998

)

Net income

 

$

3,485,900

 

$

6,908,423

 

$

4,010,592

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

See Notes to Financial Statements.

 

3



 

 

Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC and Subsidiary

 

Consolidated Statements Of Members’ Equity

Years Ended November 2002, 2001, and 2000

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

2000

 

Balance, beginning

 

$

17,825,796

 

$

20,086,187

 

$

18,646,986

 

Net income

 

3,485,900

 

6,908,423

 

4,010,592

 

Member distributions

 

(1,893,684

)

(9,168,814

)

(2,571,391

)

Balance, ending

 

$

19,418,012

 

$

17,825,796

 

$

20,086,187

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

See Notes to Financial Statements.

 

4



 

 

Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC and Subsidiary

 

Consolidated Statements Of Cash Flows

Years Ended November 2002, 2001, and 2000

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

2000

 

Cash Flows From Operating Activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

$

3,485,900

 

$

6,908,423

 

$

4,010,592

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation

 

883,921

 

848,262

 

600,665

 

Loss on disposition of equipment

 

245,702

 

36,424

 

120,010

 

Change in assets and liabilities, net of effects of acquisition of Datron Corporation in 2002:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Decrease (increase) in:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trade receivables

 

36,258

 

(1,403,421

)

2,000,219

 

Inventories

 

1,499,521

 

6,517,967

 

185,596

 

Prepaid expenses

 

20,487

 

(76,841

)

(4,467

)

Increase (decrease) in:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

202,457

 

472,405

 

(845,421

)

Accrued expenses

 

451,127

 

105,667

 

91,961

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

6,825,373

 

13,408,886

 

6,159,155

 

Cash Flows From Investing Activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds on sale of equipment

 

42,112

 

71,574

 

6,367

 

Purchase of leasehold improvements and equipment

 

(447,237

)

(635,402

)

(915,292

)

Disbursements on note receivable

 

(1,000,000

)

 

 

Purchase of available-for-sale securities

 

 

(6,767,969

)

 

Proceeds from sale of available-for-sale securities

 

965,000

 

5,802,969

 

 

Purchase of Datron Corporation assets

 

(3,000,000

)

 

 

Net cash (used in) investing activities

 

(3,440,125

)

(1,528,828

)

(908,925

)

Cash Flows From Financing Activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net payments on revolving credit agreement

 

 

(1,584,521

)

(3,415,479

)

Member distributions

 

(1,893,684

)

(9,168,814

)

(2,571,391

)

Net cash (used in) financing activities

 

(1,893,684

)

(10,753,335

)

(5,986,870

)

Increase in cash and cash equivalents

 

1,491,564

 

1,126,723

 

(736,640

)

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning

 

1,463,009

 

336,286

 

1,072,926

 

Cash and cash equivalents, ending

 

$

2,954,573

 

$

1,463,009

 

$

336,286

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

See Notes to Financial Statements.

 

5



 

Audovox Specialized Applications, LLC And Subsidiary

Notes To Financial Statements

Note 1.                                  Nature of Business, Use of Estimates, and Significant Accounting Policies

 

Nature of business:

 

Audiovox Specialized Applications (“ASA”) “The Mobile Electronics Company” is an international supplier of mobile electronics for the Automotive Industry including: Recreational Vehicle, Van/SUV Conversion, Commercial Vehicle, Heavy Duty Truck, Agricultural, Construction, Bus, Limousine, and Marine industries.  Its proprietary line of products include: Flexvision LCD Entertainment Systems, including DVD and video cassette players; Voyager Rear Observation and Bus Monitor/PA Systems and radios; Audiovox Televisions, and other Audio/Video Products; Nextgen Modular Chassis Systems; Aquatronics Marine Radios, Speakers, and Housings; Heavy Duty Systems, Radios and other Audio Products; CruiseTV satellite television systems.  These products are sold to customers throughout the world, generally on 30-day terms.  ASA is headquartered in Elkhart, Indiana and has other branch locations in Ft. Worth, Texas; Temecula, California; and Lavonia, Georgia.

 

Use of estimates:

 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 

Significant accounting policies:

 

Revenue recognition:

 

The Company recognizes revenue from product sales at the time of passage of title and risk of loss to the customer either at FOB Shipping Point or FOB Destination, based upon terms established with the customer.  The Company’s price is fixed and determined at the time of shipment and collectibility is reasonably assured and not contingent upon the customer’s resale of the product.  The customers are not given rights of return no are sales incentives provided.  The product sale is not subject to acceptance or installation by Company or customer personnel.

 

The Company recognizes royalty revenue at the time the related product is sold to a third party by Audiovox Corporation, a member of ASA, under the terms of the related royalty agreement.  Total royalty revenue under this agreement for the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 was approximately $3,140,000, $1,484,000 and $1,452,000 respectively.

 

Member equity:

 

In accordance with the generally accepted method of presenting limited liability company financial statements, the accompanying financial statements do not include other corporate assets and liabilities of the members, including their obligation for income taxes on the net income of the limited liability company nor any provision for income tax expense.

 

It is the Company’s intent to distribute funds to members to cover their income tax liabilities.  No provision has been made for any distributions which may be made subsequent to the balance sheet date.

 

6



 

The LLC operating agreement does not provide for separate classes of ownership.  Audiovox and ASA Electronics Corporation share equally in all LLC events and the related member accounts are considered equal on a fair value basis.

 

Principles of consolidation:

 

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and CruiseTV, LLC (“CruiseTV”) a wholly-owned subsidiary.  All significant intercompany accounts have been eliminated in consolidation.

 

Cash and cash equivalents:

 

The Company maintains its cash accounts in two commercial banks in amounts which, at times, may be in excess of insurance limits provided by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.

 

For purposes of the statement of cash flows, the Company considers investments in various repurchase agreements with its bank to be cash equivalents.

 

Available-for-sale securities:

 

At November 30, 2001, the Company owned tax-exempt bonds, which were classified as available-for-sale marketable debt securities.

 

 The Company accounts for these investments in accordance with FASB Statement No. 115.  Management determines the appropriate classification of securities at the date individual investment securities are acquired and the appropriateness of such classification is reassessed at each balance sheet date.  Since the Company neither buys investment securities in anticipation of short-term fluctuation in market prices nor commits to holding debt securities to their maturities, the investments in debt and equity securities have been classified as available-for-sale in accordance with Statement No. 115.  Available-for-sale securities are stated at fair value, and unrealized holding gains and losses, if any, are reported as a separate component of members’ equity.

 

Trade receivables:

 

Trade receivables in the accompanying balance sheets at November 30, 2002 and 2001 are stated net of an allowance for doubtful accounts of approximately $59,000 and $25,000 respectively.

 

Inventories:

 

Inventories consist principally of finished goods and are stated at the lower of cost (primarily on a weighted moving average basis) or market.

 

7



 

Depreciation:

 

Depreciation of leasehold improvements and equipment is computed principally by the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets.

 

Long-lived assets and goodwill:

 

In July 2001, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standard (“SFAS”) No. 141, Business Combinations, and SFAS No. 142. SFAS No. 141 requires that the purchase method of accounting be used for all future business combinations and specifies criteria intangible assets acquired in a business combination must meet to be recognized and reported apart from goodwill.

 

Statement of Financial Accounting Standard (“SFAS”) No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, requires that goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives no longer be amortized, but instead tested for impairment at least annually or more frequently if an event occurs or circumstances change that could more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying amount.

 

As a result of adopting the provisions of SFAS No. 142, the Company did not record amortization expense relating to its goodwill. The Company performed its annual impairment test for goodwill, which indicated no reduction is required.

 

In accordance with SFAS No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets, the Company reviews its long-lived assets periodically to determine potential impairment by comparing the carrying value of the long-lived assets with the estimated future net undiscounted cash flows expected to result from the use of the assets, including cash flows from disposition.  Should the sum of the expected future net cash flows be less that the carrying value, the Company would recognize an impairment loss at that date.  An impairment loss would be measured by comparing the amount by which the carrying value exceeds the fair value of the long-lived assets.  The Company performed its annual impairment test, which indicated no reduction is required.

 

Warranties:

 

The Company follows the policy of accruing an estimated liability for warranties at the time the warranted products are sold.

 

Income taxes:

 

The members have elected to be taxed for federal and state income tax purposes as a limited liability company under the provisions of the respective income tax codes.  Under these provisions, the members report net income of the Company on their corporate income tax returns.

 

8



 

Note 2.                                  Investment in Debt Securities

 

The following is a summary of the Company’s investment in available-for-sale securities as of November 30, 2001.

 

 

 

 

Gross

 

Gross

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amortized

 

Unrealized

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

 

 

Cost

 

Gains

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Municipal bonds

 

$

965,000

 

$

 

$

 

$

965,000

 

 

 

The amortized cost and fair value of debt securities as available-for-sale by maturity as of November 30, 2001 are as follows:

 

 

 

 

Amortized

 

Fair

 

 

 

Cost

 

Value

 

Due within one year

 

$

10,000

 

$

10,000

 

Due after one year through three years

 

245,000

 

245,000

 

Due after three years

 

710,000

 

710,000

 

 

 

$

965,000

 

$

965,000

 

 

Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because the issuers of certain debt securities do have the right to call or prepay their obligations without any penalties.  The amount classified as current assets on the accompanying balance sheet as of November 30, 2001, represent the amount of marketable equity securities expected to be sold during the next year and the expected maturities of the debt securities during the next year.

 

A summary of proceeds from the sale of available-for-sale securities and investment earnings for the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 is as follows:

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

2000

 

Proceeds from the sale of available-for-sale securities

 

$

965,000

 

$

5,802,969

 

$

 

Interest earned

 

$

130,370

 

$

82,058

 

$

36,390

 

 

Note 3.                                  Note Receivable

 

The Company has an outstanding note receivable in the amount of $1,000,000 due January 2003.  The note bears interest at 10% payable monthly and is unsecured.

 

9



 

Note 4.                                  Leasehold Improvements and Equipment

 

The cost of leasehold improvements and equipment and the related accumulated depreciation at November 30, 2002 and 2001 are as follows:

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

Leasehold improvements

 

$

870,205

 

$

868,559

 

Machinery and equipment

 

833,297

 

885,830

 

Tooling and molding

 

1,626,590

 

1,510,982

 

Transportation equipment

 

350,914

 

312,947

 

Office furniture and fixtures

 

193,757

 

191,056

 

Computer equipment

 

671,151

 

656,138

 

Booth displays

 

157,884

 

153,144

 

Construction in progress

 

82,410

 

3,745

 

 

 

4,786,208

 

4,582,401

 

Less accumulated depreciation

 

2,754,033

 

2,187,373

 

 

 

$

2,032,175

 

$

2,395,028

 

 

Note 5.                                  Pledged Assets and Notes Payable

 

The terms of a loan agreement with a bank permit the Company to borrow a maximum of $17,000,000, subject to a borrowing base determined by eligible accounts receivable and inventories.  At both November 30, 2002 and 2001, no amounts were outstanding under this agreement.  Borrowings under the agreement bear interest at prime (4.25% at November 30, 2002) minus 1.25% or LIBOR plus an applicable margin, at the Company’s option, are collateralized by accounts receivable, inventories, and equipment, and are due on demand.  In connection with the agreement, the Company is subject to certain financial covenants.

 

Note 6.                                  Major Customer

 

No customers or contracts comprised more than 10% of total net sales for the years ended November 30, 2002 and 2000.  Net sales during the year ended November 30, 2001 included a contract with one customer that totaled approximately $18,000,000.

 

Note 7.                                  Major Vendors

 

For the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000, the Company purchased approximately 50%, 50%, and 46% of its products for resale from three vendors, two of which were the same in all three years.

 

10



 

Note 8.                                  Transactions with Related Parties and Lease Commitments

 

The Company is affiliated with various entities through common ownership by one of its members, Audiovox Corporation (“Audiovox”).  Transactions with Audiovox for the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 are approximately as follows:

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

2000

 

Net product sales

 

$

1,898,000

 

$

5,522,000

 

$

6,804,000

 

Royalty revenue

 

3,140,000

 

1,484,000

 

1,452,000

 

Purchases

 

1,916,000

 

1,124,000

 

1,363,000

 

 

 

The Company has a royalty agreement with Audiovox whereby the Company earns a 3% royalty on the member’s purchases of certain mobile video product from a third party.

 

At November 30, 2002 and 2001, amounts included in trade receivables and accounts payable resulting from the above transactions are as follows:

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

Trade receivables

 

$

666,827

 

$

506,629

 

Accounts payable

 

378,390

 

208,826

 

 

The Company also leases warehouse, manufacturing, and office facilities from Irions Investments, LLC, an entity related through common ownership, for approximately $27,000 per month, plus the payment of property taxes, normal maintenance, and insurance on the property under an agreement which expires July 31, 2006, with three five-year options to extend, at the Company’s discretion.

 

The Company leases three other facilities from unrelated parties under agreements expiring between February 2003 and October 2004.  These agreements require aggregate monthly rentals totaling approximately $7,300, plus the payment of property taxes, normal maintenance, and insurance on the properties.  In addition, the Company leases certain equipment from unrelated parties under agreements that require monthly payments totaling approximately $4,500 and expires through July 2006.

 

The total rental expense included in the income statements for the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 is approximately $450,000, $474,000, and $477,000 respectively, of which approximately $328,000, $319,000 and $314,000 respectively was paid to Irions Investments, LLC.

 

11



 

The total approximate minimum rental commitment at November 30, 2002 under the leases is due as follows:

 

 

 

Related Party

 

Other

 

Total

 

During the year ending November 30,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2003

 

$

324,000

 

$

70,000

 

$

394,000

 

2004

 

324,000

 

55,000

 

379,000

 

2005

 

324,000

 

13,000

 

337,000

 

2006

 

216,000

 

9,000

 

225,000

 

 

 

$

1,188,000

 

$

147,000

 

$

1,335,000

 

 

Note 9.                                  Employee Benefit Plans

 

The Company has profit-sharing and 401(k) plans for the benefit of all eligible employees.  The Company’s contributions are discretionary with the Board of Directors and are limited to amounts deductible for federal income tax purposes.  Discretionary contributions were approximately $88,000, $115,000, and 114,000 for the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 respectively.

 

The Company also maintains a discretionary employee bonus plan for the benefit of its key executive and operating officers.  The Company has paid or accrued bonuses of approximately $695,000, $1,115,000, and $666,000 during the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 respectively.

 

The Company has a health plan for its employees, which is self-insured for medical and pharmaceutical claims up to $10,000 per participant and approximately $350,000 annually in aggregate.  Dental and vision coverage is entirely self-insured.  The excess loss portion of the employees’ coverage has been reinsured with a commercial carrier.  The total amount of net claims and insurance premiums for the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 was approximately $402,000, $513,700, and $456,800 respectively.

 

Note 10.                           Business Combination

 

On March 8, 2002, CruiseTV acquired substantially all of the assets of Datron Corporation.  Datron Corporation was a manufacturer of mobile satellite television systems for distribution generally in the United States.  As a result of the acquisition, CruiseTV expects to be the leading distributor of mobile satellite television systems.

 

The acquisition has been accounted for as a purchase and results of operations since the date of acquisition are included in the consolidated financial statements.

 

The aggregate purchase price was $3,000,000 including $1,500,000 in cash, $1,244,000 in the form of a six-month promissory note, and a deferred payment of $256,000.  The deferred payment is contingent upon the satisfaction of certain warranty claims in excess of a threshold agreed to in the purchase agreement.  The total amount of the deferred payment was placed in an escrow account, included in cash and cash equivalents on the balance sheet at November 30, 2002.  The allocation of the disbursement of the escrow account between the two parties is uncertain at November 30, 2002.  The acquisition resulted in goodwill of $300,000, all of which is deductible for tax purposes.

 

12



 

Unaudited proforma consolidated results of operations for the years ended November 30, 2002 and 2001 as though the assets of Datron Corporation had been acquired as of December 1, 2000 are approximately as follows:

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

Net sales

 

$

47,987,000

 

$

68,930,000

 

Net income

 

$

3,504,000

 

$

6,406,000

 

 

Note 11.                           Litigation

 

The Company has pending legal proceedings that generally involve product liability and employment issues.  These proceedings are, in the opinion of management, ordinary routine matters incidental to the normal business conducted by the Company.  In the opinion of management the ultimate disposition of such proceedings are not expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 

Note 12.                           Cash Flows Information

 

Supplemental information relative to the statements of cash flows for the years ended November 30, 2002, 2001, and 2000 is as follows:

 

 

 

2002

 

2001

 

2000

 

Supplemental disclosures of cash flows information:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash payments for interest

 

$

 

$

62,410

 

$

119,727

 

Supplemental schedule of noncash investing and financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Acquisition of Datron Corporation,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

March 2002:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

$

506,000

 

$

 

$

 

Inventory

 

1,832,000

 

 

 

Equipment

 

362,000

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

300,000

 

 

 

Net cash

 

$

3,000,000

 

$

 

$

 

 

Note 13.                           Reclassification

 

Certain items in the financial statements for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2000 have been reclassified, with no effect on net income, to conform with the classifications used for the year ended November 30, 2002.

 

 

13


Exhibit 99.2

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

We have issued our report, dated December 26, 2002, on the consolidated financial statements of Audiovox Specialized Applications, LLC which are included in the Amendment to the Annual Report of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries on Form 10-K/A for the year ended November 30, 2002.  We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference of our report in the Registration Statements of Audiovox Corporation on Forms S-8 (Registration Nos. 333-36762 and 333-82073).

 

 

/s/ MCGLADREY & PULLEN, LLP

 

MCGLADREY & PULLEN, LLP

 

 

Elkhart, Indiana

October 5, 2004